Doco LE O32 sizeof(struct) < 4 problem.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518
KB
2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
e9c75b65 34@set DATE April 2001
c906108c 35
6d2ebf8b 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
e9c75b65
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
60Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
61with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
e9c75b65
EZ
63(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
65Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
66@end ifinfo
67
68@titlepage
69@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 71@sp 1
c906108c
SS
72@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 74@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 75@page
c906108c
SS
76@tex
77{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 78\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
79\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81}
82@end tex
53a5351d 83
c906108c 84@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
e9c75b65
EZ
85Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 87@sp 2
c906108c
SS
88Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
8959 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 91ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
92
93Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
96Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
97Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
98with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
99
100(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
102Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
103@end titlepage
104@page
105
b9deaee7 106@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
107@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
c906108c
SS
109@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
5d161b24 113This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
114@value{GDBVN}.
115
e9c75b65 116Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
117
118@menu
119* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
120* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
122* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
124* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
126* Stack:: Examining the stack
127* Source:: Examining source files
128* Data:: Examining data
b37052ae 129* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
6d2ebf8b
SS
130
131* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
132
133* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
134* Altering:: Altering execution
135* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
136* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
137* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
138* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
139* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
140* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
141* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 142* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
143
144* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
145* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
146
147* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
148* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
149* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
150* Index:: Index
151@end menu
152
b9deaee7 153@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
154
155@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
156
157@ifhtml
158@node Top
159
160@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
161
162This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
163
b37052ae 164This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
6d2ebf8b
SS
165@value{GDBVN}.
166
167Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
168
c906108c
SS
169@menu
170* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 171* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
172
173* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
174* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
175* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
176* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
177* Stack:: Examining the stack
178* Source:: Examining source files
179* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 180
7a292a7a 181* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
182
183* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
184* Altering:: Altering execution
185* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
186* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 187* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
188* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
189* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 190* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 191* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
c906108c
SS
192
193* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 194* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
195
196* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
197* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
198* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
199* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
200@end menu
201
6d2ebf8b
SS
202@end ifhtml
203
449f3b6c
AC
204@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
205@iftex
206@contents
207@end iftex
208
6d2ebf8b 209@node Summary
c906108c
SS
210@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
211
212The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
213going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
214program was doing at the moment it crashed.
215
216@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
217these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
218
219@itemize @bullet
220@item
221Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
222
223@item
224Make your program stop on specified conditions.
225
226@item
227Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
228
229@item
230Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
231effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
232@end itemize
233
cce74817 234You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 235For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
236For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
237
cce74817
JM
238@cindex Chill
239@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 240Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 241see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 242
cce74817
JM
243@cindex Pascal
244Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
245nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
246entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
247syntax.
c906108c 248
c906108c
SS
249@cindex Fortran
250@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 251it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 252underscore.
c906108c 253
c906108c
SS
254@menu
255* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
256* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257@end menu
258
6d2ebf8b 259@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
260@unnumberedsec Free software
261
5d161b24 262@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
263General Public License
264(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273from anyone else.
274
6d2ebf8b 275@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
276@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
277
278Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
279other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
280development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
281of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
282to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
283file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
284blow-by-blow account.
285
286Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
287
288@quotation
289@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
290or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
291omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
292@end quotation
293
294So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
295particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
296releases:
b37052ae 297Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
298Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
299Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
300Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
301Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
302Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
303John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
304Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
305and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
306
307Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
308Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
309
b37052ae
EZ
310Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
311in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
312Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
313demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
314much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 315
b37052ae 316@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
317object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
318Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
319
320David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
321the original support for encapsulated COFF.
322
96c405b3 323Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
324
325Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
326Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
327support.
328Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
329Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
330Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
331David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
332Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
333Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
334Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
335Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
336Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
337Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
338Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
339Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
340Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
341Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
342Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
343
344Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
345
346Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
347libraries.
348
349Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
350about several machine instruction sets.
351
352Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
353remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
354contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
355and RDI targets, respectively.
356
357Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
358command-line editing and command history.
359
7a292a7a
SS
360Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
361Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 362
5d161b24 363Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 364He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 365symbols.
c906108c
SS
366
367Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
368Super-H processors.
369
370NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
371
372Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
373
374Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
375
376Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
377
96a2c332 378Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
379
380Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
381watchpoints.
382
383Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
384
385Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
386
387Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 388nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
389
390The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
391support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 392(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
393compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
394John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
395Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
396information in this manual.
397
b37052ae
EZ
398DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
399Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
400
96a2c332
SS
401Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
402development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
403fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
404Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
405Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
406Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
407Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
408addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
409JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
410Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
411Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
412Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
413Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
414Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
415Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
416
417
6d2ebf8b 418@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
419@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
420
421You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
422However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
423debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
424
425@iftex
426In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
427to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
428@end iftex
429
430@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
431@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
432
433One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
434processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
435quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
436definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
437session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
438then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
439same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
440@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
441procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
442
443@smallexample
444$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
445$ @b{./m4}
446@b{define(foo,0000)}
447
448@b{foo}
4490000
450@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
451
452@b{bar}
4530000
454@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
455
456@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
457@b{baz}
458@b{C-d}
459m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
460@end smallexample
461
462@noindent
463Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
464
c906108c
SS
465@smallexample
466$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
467@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
468@c FIXME... format to come out better.
469@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 470 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 471 the conditions.
5d161b24 472There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
473 for details.
474
475@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
476(@value{GDBP})
477@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
478
479@noindent
480@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
481rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
482We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
483that examples fit in this manual.
484
485@smallexample
486(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
487@end smallexample
488
489@noindent
490We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
491Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
492@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
493@code{break} command.
494
495@smallexample
496(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
497Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
498@end smallexample
499
500@noindent
501Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
502control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
503subroutine, the program runs as usual:
504
505@smallexample
506(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
507Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
508@b{define(foo,0000)}
509
510@b{foo}
5110000
512@end smallexample
513
514@noindent
515To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
516suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
517context where it stops.
518
519@smallexample
520@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
521
5d161b24 522Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
523 at builtin.c:879
524879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
525@end smallexample
526
527@noindent
528Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
529the next line of the current function.
530
531@smallexample
532(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
534 : nil,
535@end smallexample
536
537@noindent
538@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
539by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
540@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
541subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
542
543@smallexample
544(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
545set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
546 at input.c:530
547530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
548@end smallexample
549
550@noindent
551The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
552suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
553shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
554command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
555in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
556stack frame for each active subroutine.
557
558@smallexample
559(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
560#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
561 at input.c:530
5d161b24 562#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
563 at builtin.c:882
564#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
565#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
566 at macro.c:71
567#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
568#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
569@end smallexample
570
571@noindent
572We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
573times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
574falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
575
576@smallexample
577(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5780x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5800x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
581def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
582(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
583536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
584 : xstrdup(rq);
585(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
586538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
587@end smallexample
588
589@noindent
590The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
591@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
592and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
593(@code{print}) to see their values.
594
595@smallexample
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
597$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
599$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
600@end smallexample
601
602@noindent
603@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
604To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
605surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
606
607@smallexample
608(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
609533 xfree(rquote);
610534
611535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
612 : xstrdup (lq);
613536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
614 : xstrdup (rq);
615537
616538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
617539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
618540 @}
619541
620542 void
621@end smallexample
622
623@noindent
624Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
625@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
626
627@smallexample
628(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631540 @}
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
633$3 = 9
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
635$4 = 7
636@end smallexample
637
638@noindent
639That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
640@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
641@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
642the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
643any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
644assignments.
645
646@smallexample
647(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
648$5 = 7
649(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
650$6 = 9
651@end smallexample
652
653@noindent
654Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
655@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
656executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
657example that caused trouble initially:
658
659@smallexample
660(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
661Continuing.
662
663@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
664
665baz
6660000
667@end smallexample
668
669@noindent
670Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
671problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
672lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
673
674@smallexample
675@b{C-d}
676Program exited normally.
677@end smallexample
678
679@noindent
680The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
681indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
682session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
683
684@smallexample
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
686@end smallexample
c906108c 687
6d2ebf8b 688@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
689@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
690
691This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 692The essentials are:
c906108c 693@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 694@item
53a5351d 695type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 696@item
c906108c
SS
697type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
698@end itemize
699
700@menu
701* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
702* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
703* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
704@end menu
705
6d2ebf8b 706@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
707@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
708
c906108c
SS
709Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
710@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
711
712You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
713to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
714
c906108c
SS
715The command-line options described here are designed
716to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 717options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
718
719The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
720specifying an executable program:
721
722@example
723@value{GDBP} @var{program}
724@end example
725
c906108c
SS
726@noindent
727You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
728specified:
729
730@example
731@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
732@end example
733
734You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
735to debug a running process:
736
737@example
738@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
739@end example
740
741@noindent
742would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
743named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
744
c906108c 745Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
746complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
747debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
748``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
749will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 750
96a2c332 751You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
752@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
753
754@smallexample
755@value{GDBP} -silent
756@end smallexample
757
758@noindent
759You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
760options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
761
762@noindent
763Type
764
765@example
766@value{GDBP} -help
767@end example
768
769@noindent
770to display all available options and briefly describe their use
771(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
772
773All options and command line arguments you give are processed
774in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
775@samp{-x} option is used.
776
777
778@menu
c906108c
SS
779* File Options:: Choosing files
780* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
781@end menu
782
6d2ebf8b 783@node File Options
c906108c
SS
784@subsection Choosing files
785
2df3850c 786When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
787specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
788the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
789@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
790that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
791@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
792that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
793the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
794
795If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
796such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
797argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
798
799Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
800following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
801them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
802(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
803than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
804
d700128c
EZ
805@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
806@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
807@c it.
808
c906108c
SS
809@table @code
810@item -symbols @var{file}
811@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
812@cindex @code{--symbols}
813@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
814Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
815
816@item -exec @var{file}
817@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
818@cindex @code{--exec}
819@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
820Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
821and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
822
823@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 824@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
825Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
826file.
827
c906108c
SS
828@item -core @var{file}
829@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
830@cindex @code{--core}
831@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
832Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
833
834@item -c @var{number}
835Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
836(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
837case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
838
839@item -command @var{file}
840@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
841@cindex @code{--command}
842@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
843Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
844Files,, Command files}.
845
846@item -directory @var{directory}
847@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
848@cindex @code{--directory}
849@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
850Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
851
c906108c
SS
852@item -m
853@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
854@cindex @code{--mapped}
855@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
856@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
857supported on all systems.}@*
858If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 859system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
860to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
861program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 862called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
863Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
864and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
865the symbol table from the executable program.
866
867The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
868is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
869table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 870
c906108c
SS
871@item -r
872@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
873@cindex @code{--readnow}
874@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
875Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
876the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
877This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 878
c906108c
SS
879@end table
880
2df3850c 881You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 882order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
883information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
884on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
885but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
886
887@example
2df3850c 888gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 889@end example
c906108c 890
6d2ebf8b 891@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
892@subsection Choosing modes
893
894You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
895batch mode or quiet mode.
896
897@table @code
898@item -nx
899@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
900@cindex @code{--nx}
901@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
902Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
903called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
904@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
905options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
906files}.
c906108c
SS
907
908@item -quiet
d700128c 909@itemx -silent
c906108c 910@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
911@cindex @code{--quiet}
912@cindex @code{--silent}
913@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
914``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
915messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
916
917@item -batch
d700128c 918@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
919Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
920command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
921initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
922nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
923in the command files.
924
2df3850c
JM
925Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
926example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
927make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
928
929@example
930Program exited normally.
931@end example
932
933@noindent
2df3850c
JM
934(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
935@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
936mode.
937
938@item -nowindows
939@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
940@cindex @code{--nowindows}
941@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 942``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 943(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
944interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
945
946@item -windows
947@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
948@cindex @code{--windows}
949@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
950If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
951used if possible.
c906108c
SS
952
953@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 954@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
955Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
956instead of the current directory.
957
c906108c
SS
958@item -fullname
959@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
960@cindex @code{--fullname}
961@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
962@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
963subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
964number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
965displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
966recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
967the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
968and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
969@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
970frame.
c906108c 971
d700128c
EZ
972@item -epoch
973@cindex @code{--epoch}
974The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
975@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
976routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
977separate window.
978
979@item -annotate @var{level}
980@cindex @code{--annotate}
981This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
982effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
983(@pxref{Annotations}).
984Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
985together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
986types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
987@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
988maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
989
990@item -async
991@cindex @code{--async}
992Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
993@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
994special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
995commands in parallel with the debugged process being
996run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
997MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
998suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
999control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1000(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1001operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1002yet.)
1003@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1004@c should be removed.
1005
1006When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1007uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1008@samp{-noasync} option.
1009
1010@item -noasync
1011@cindex @code{--noasync}
1012Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1013
2df3850c
JM
1014@item -baud @var{bps}
1015@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1016@cindex @code{--baud}
1017@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1018Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1019interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1020
1021@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1022@itemx -t @var{device}
1023@cindex @code{--tty}
1024@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1025Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1026@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1027
53a5351d
JM
1028@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1029@c @item -tui
d700128c 1030@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
1031@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1032@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1033@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1034@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1035@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1036
1037@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1038@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1039@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1040@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1041@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1042@c systems.
1043
d700128c
EZ
1044@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1045@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1046Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1047program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1048communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1049
1050@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1051@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1052@sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1053@value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
d700128c
EZ
1054
1055@item -write
1056@cindex @code{--write}
1057Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1058is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1059(@pxref{Patching}).
1060
1061@item -statistics
1062@cindex @code{--statistics}
1063This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1064memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1065
1066@item -version
1067@cindex @code{--version}
1068This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1069no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1070
c906108c
SS
1071@end table
1072
6d2ebf8b 1073@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1074@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1075@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1076@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1077
1078@table @code
1079@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1080@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1081@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1082@itemx q
1083To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1084@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1085do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1086otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1087error code.
c906108c
SS
1088@end table
1089
1090@cindex interrupt
1091An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1092terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1093returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1094character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1095until a time when it is safe.
1096
c906108c
SS
1097If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1098device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1099(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1100
6d2ebf8b 1101@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1102@section Shell commands
1103
1104If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1105debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1106just use the @code{shell} command.
1107
1108@table @code
1109@kindex shell
1110@cindex shell escape
1111@item shell @var{command string}
1112Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1113If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1114shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1115(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1116@end table
1117
1118The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1119You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1120@value{GDBN}:
1121
1122@table @code
1123@kindex make
1124@cindex calling make
1125@item make @var{make-args}
1126Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1127arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1128@end table
1129
6d2ebf8b 1130@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1131@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1132
1133You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1134name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1135@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1136key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1137show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1138
1139@menu
1140* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1141* Completion:: Command completion
1142* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1143@end menu
1144
6d2ebf8b 1145@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1146@section Command syntax
1147
1148A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1149how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1150arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1151command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1152step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1153with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1154
1155@cindex abbreviation
1156@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1157unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1158documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1159abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1160equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1161names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1162arguments to the @code{help} command.
1163
1164@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1165@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1166A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1167repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1168will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1169repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1170repeat.
1171
1172The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1173@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1174exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1175
1176@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1177output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1178(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1179@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1180repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1181
41afff9a 1182@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1183@cindex comment
1184Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1185nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1186Files,,Command files}).
1187
6d2ebf8b 1188@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1189@section Command completion
1190
1191@cindex completion
1192@cindex word completion
1193@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1194only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1195are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1196commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1197
1198Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1199of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1200word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1201enter it). For example, if you type
1202
1203@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1204@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1205@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1206@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1207@example
1208(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1209@end example
1210
1211@noindent
1212@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1213the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1214
1215@example
1216(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1217@end example
1218
1219@noindent
1220You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1221breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1222@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1223were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1224might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1225to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1226
1227If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1228@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1229characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1230@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1231example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1232begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1233just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1234function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1235example:
1236
1237@example
1238(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1239@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1240make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1241make_abs_section make_function_type
1242make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1243make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1244make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1245(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1246@end example
1247
1248@noindent
1249After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1250partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1251command.
1252
1253If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1254can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1255means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1256key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1257one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1258
1259@cindex quotes in commands
1260@cindex completion of quoted strings
1261Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1262parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1263its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1264situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1265@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1266
c906108c 1267The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1268name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1269overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1270by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1271may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1272that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1273that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1274word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1275@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1276@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1277when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c
SS
1278
1279@example
96a2c332 1280(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1281bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1282(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1283@end example
1284
1285In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1286quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1287completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1288place:
1289
1290@example
1291(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1292@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1293(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1294@end example
1295
1296@noindent
1297In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1298you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1299completion on an overloaded symbol.
1300
d4f3574e 1301For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1302expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1303overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1304see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1305
1306
6d2ebf8b 1307@node Help
c906108c
SS
1308@section Getting help
1309@cindex online documentation
1310@kindex help
1311
5d161b24 1312You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1313using the command @code{help}.
1314
1315@table @code
41afff9a 1316@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1317@item help
1318@itemx h
1319You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1320display a short list of named classes of commands:
1321
1322@smallexample
1323(@value{GDBP}) help
1324List of classes of commands:
1325
2df3850c 1326aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1327breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1328data -- Examining data
c906108c 1329files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1330internals -- Maintenance commands
1331obscure -- Obscure features
1332running -- Running the program
1333stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1334status -- Status inquiries
1335support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1336tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1337 stopping the program
c906108c 1338user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1339
5d161b24 1340Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1341commands in that class.
5d161b24 1342Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1343documentation.
1344Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1345(@value{GDBP})
1346@end smallexample
96a2c332 1347@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1348
1349@item help @var{class}
1350Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1351list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1352help display for the class @code{status}:
1353
1354@smallexample
1355(@value{GDBP}) help status
1356Status inquiries.
1357
1358List of commands:
1359
1360@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1361@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1362info -- Generic command for showing things
1363 about the program being debugged
1364show -- Generic command for showing things
1365 about the debugger
c906108c 1366
5d161b24 1367Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1368documentation.
1369Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1370(@value{GDBP})
1371@end smallexample
1372
1373@item help @var{command}
1374With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1375short paragraph on how to use that command.
1376
6837a0a2
DB
1377@kindex apropos
1378@item apropos @var{args}
1379The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1380commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1381@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1382
1383@smallexample
1384apropos reload
1385@end smallexample
1386
b37052ae
EZ
1387@noindent
1388results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1389
1390@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1391@c @group
1392set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1393 multiple times in one run
1394show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1395 multiple times in one run
1396@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1397@end smallexample
1398
c906108c
SS
1399@kindex complete
1400@item complete @var{args}
1401The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1402for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1403command you want completed. For example:
1404
1405@smallexample
1406complete i
1407@end smallexample
1408
1409@noindent results in:
1410
1411@smallexample
1412@group
2df3850c
JM
1413if
1414ignore
c906108c
SS
1415info
1416inspect
c906108c
SS
1417@end group
1418@end smallexample
1419
1420@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1421@end table
1422
1423In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1424and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1425of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1426manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1427under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1428all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1429
1430@c @group
1431@table @code
1432@kindex info
41afff9a 1433@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1434@item info
1435This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1436program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1437with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1438registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1439You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1440@w{@code{help info}}.
1441
1442@kindex set
1443@item set
5d161b24 1444You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1445@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1446@code{set prompt $}.
1447
1448@kindex show
1449@item show
5d161b24 1450In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1451@value{GDBN} itself.
1452You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1453related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1454system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1455which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1456
1457@kindex info set
1458To display all the settable parameters and their current
1459values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1460@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1461@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1462@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1463@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1464@end table
1465@c @end group
1466
1467Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1468exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1469
1470@table @code
1471@kindex show version
1472@cindex version number
1473@item show version
1474Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1475information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1476@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1477version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1478commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1479system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1480variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1481The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1482@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1483
1484@kindex show copying
1485@item show copying
1486Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1487
1488@kindex show warranty
1489@item show warranty
2df3850c 1490Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1491if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1492
c906108c
SS
1493@end table
1494
6d2ebf8b 1495@node Running
c906108c
SS
1496@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1497
1498When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1499debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1500
1501You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1502of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1503your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1504kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1505
1506@menu
1507* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1508* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1509* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1510* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1511
1512* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1513* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1514* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1515* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1516
1517* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1518* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1519@end menu
1520
6d2ebf8b 1521@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1522@section Compiling for debugging
1523
1524In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1525debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1526is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1527variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1528and addresses in the executable code.
1529
1530To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1531the compiler.
1532
1533Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1534options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1535executables containing debugging information.
1536
53a5351d
JM
1537@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1538without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1539recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1540program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1541in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1542
1543@cindex optimized code, debugging
1544@cindex debugging optimized code
1545When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1546optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1547really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1548exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1549variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1550variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1551
1552Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1553@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1554doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1555please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1556
1557Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1558@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1559format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1560
1561@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1562@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1563@section Starting your program
1564@cindex starting
1565@cindex running
1566
1567@table @code
1568@kindex run
41afff9a 1569@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1570@item run
1571@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1572Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1573You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1574argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1575@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1576(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1577
1578@end table
1579
c906108c
SS
1580If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1581supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1582that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1583@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1584
1585The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1586receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1587information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1588can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1589your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1590divided into four categories:
1591
1592@table @asis
1593@item The @emph{arguments.}
1594Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1595@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1596is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1597(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1598the arguments.
1599In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1600@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1601@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1602
1603@item The @emph{environment.}
1604Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1605use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1606environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1607your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1608
1609@item The @emph{working directory.}
1610Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1611the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1612@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1613
1614@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1615Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1616standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1617in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1618set a different device for your program.
1619@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1620
1621@cindex pipes
1622@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1623pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1624program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1625wrong program.
1626@end table
c906108c
SS
1627
1628When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1629immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1630of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1631stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1632or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1633
1634If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1635time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1636table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1637your current breakpoints.
1638
6d2ebf8b 1639@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1640@section Your program's arguments
1641
1642@cindex arguments (to your program)
1643The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1644@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1645They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1646performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1647@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1648@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1649the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1650
1651On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1652@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1653calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1654the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1655
1656@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1657@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1658
c906108c 1659@table @code
41afff9a 1660@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1661@item set args
1662Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1663@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1664with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1665using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1666it again without arguments.
1667
1668@kindex show args
1669@item show args
1670Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1671@end table
1672
6d2ebf8b 1673@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1674@section Your program's environment
1675
1676@cindex environment (of your program)
1677The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1678their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1679your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1680path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1681the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1682debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1683environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1684
1685@table @code
1686@kindex path
1687@item path @var{directory}
1688Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1689(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1690The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1691You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1692system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1693MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1694is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1695
1696You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1697working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1698use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1699@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1700@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1701@var{directory} to the search path.
1702@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1703@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1704
1705@kindex show paths
1706@item show paths
1707Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1708environment variable).
1709
1710@kindex show environment
1711@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1712Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1713your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1714print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1715your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1716
1717@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1718@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1719Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1720changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1721be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1722any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1723parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1724null value.
1725@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1726@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1727
1728For example, this command:
1729
1730@example
1731set env USER = foo
1732@end example
1733
1734@noindent
d4f3574e 1735tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1736@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1737are not actually required.)
1738
1739@kindex unset environment
1740@item unset environment @var{varname}
1741Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1742program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1743@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1744rather than assigning it an empty value.
1745@end table
1746
d4f3574e
SS
1747@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1748the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1749by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1750@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1751that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1752@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1753your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1754files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1755@file{.profile}.
1756
6d2ebf8b 1757@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1758@section Your program's working directory
1759
1760@cindex working directory (of your program)
1761Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1762working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1763The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1764from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1765working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1766
1767The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1768that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1769specify files}.
1770
1771@table @code
1772@kindex cd
1773@item cd @var{directory}
1774Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1775
1776@kindex pwd
1777@item pwd
1778Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1779@end table
1780
6d2ebf8b 1781@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1782@section Your program's input and output
1783
1784@cindex redirection
1785@cindex i/o
1786@cindex terminal
1787By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1788the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1789to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1790modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1791running your program.
1792
1793@table @code
1794@kindex info terminal
1795@item info terminal
1796Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1797program is using.
1798@end table
1799
1800You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1801redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1802
1803@example
1804run > outfile
1805@end example
1806
1807@noindent
1808starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1809
1810@kindex tty
1811@cindex controlling terminal
1812Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1813with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1814argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1815commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1816process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1817
1818@example
1819tty /dev/ttyb
1820@end example
1821
1822@noindent
1823directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1824default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1825that as their controlling terminal.
1826
1827An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1828effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1829terminal.
1830
1831When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1832command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1833for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1834
6d2ebf8b 1835@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1836@section Debugging an already-running process
1837@kindex attach
1838@cindex attach
1839
1840@table @code
1841@item attach @var{process-id}
1842This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1843outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1844targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1845find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1846or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1847
1848@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1849executing the command.
1850@end table
1851
1852To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1853which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1854programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1855also have permission to send the process a signal.
1856
1857When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1858the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1859the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1860(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1861the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1862Specify Files}.
1863
1864The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1865process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1866with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1867you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1868can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1869process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1870attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1871
1872@table @code
1873@kindex detach
1874@item detach
1875When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1876@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1877the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1878that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1879are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1880@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1881executing the command.
1882@end table
1883
1884If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1885attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1886for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1887control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1888confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1889messages}).
1890
6d2ebf8b 1891@node Kill Process
c906108c 1892@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1893
1894@table @code
1895@kindex kill
1896@item kill
1897Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1898@end table
1899
1900This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1901running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1902is running.
1903
1904On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1905while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1906@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1907outside the debugger.
1908
1909The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1910relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1911executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1912next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1913reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1914breakpoint settings).
1915
6d2ebf8b 1916@node Threads
c906108c 1917@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1918
1919@cindex threads of execution
1920@cindex multiple threads
1921@cindex switching threads
1922In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1923may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1924of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1925the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1926that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1927modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1928registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1929
1930@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1931programs:
1932
1933@itemize @bullet
1934@item automatic notification of new threads
1935@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1936@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1937@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1938a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1939@item thread-specific breakpoints
1940@end itemize
1941
c906108c
SS
1942@quotation
1943@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1944@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1945If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1946effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1947from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1948like this:
1949
1950@smallexample
1951(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1952(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1953Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1954see the IDs of currently known threads.
1955@end smallexample
1956@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1957@c doesn't support threads"?
1958@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1959
1960@cindex focus of debugging
1961@cindex current thread
1962The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1963threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1964control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1965This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1966program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1967
41afff9a 1968@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1969@cindex thread identifier (system)
1970@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1971@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1972@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1973Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1974the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1975form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1976whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1977LynxOS, you might see
1978
1979@example
1980[New process 35 thread 27]
1981@end example
1982
1983@noindent
1984when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1985the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1986further qualifier.
1987
1988@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1989@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1990@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1991@c program?
1992@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1993@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 1994@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
1995
1996@cindex thread number
1997@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1998For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1999number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2000
2001@table @code
2002@kindex info threads
2003@item info threads
2004Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2005program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2006
2007@enumerate
2008@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2009
2010@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2011
2012@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2013@end enumerate
2014
2015@noindent
2016An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2017indicates the current thread.
2018
5d161b24 2019For example,
c906108c
SS
2020@end table
2021@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2022
2023@smallexample
2024(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2025 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2026 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2027* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2028 at threadtest.c:68
2029@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2030
2031On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2032
2033@cindex thread number
2034@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2035For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2036number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2037thread in your program.
2038
41afff9a
EZ
2039@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2040@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2041@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2042@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2043@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2044Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2045both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2046form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2047whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2048HP-UX, you see
2049
2050@example
2051[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2052@end example
2053
2054@noindent
5d161b24 2055when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2056
2057@table @code
2058@kindex info threads
2059@item info threads
2060Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2061program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2062
2063@enumerate
2064@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2065
2066@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2067
2068@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2069@end enumerate
2070
2071@noindent
2072An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2073indicates the current thread.
2074
5d161b24 2075For example,
c906108c
SS
2076@end table
2077@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2078
2079@example
2080(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2081 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2082 at quicksort.c:137
2083 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2084 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2085 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2086 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2087@end example
c906108c
SS
2088
2089@table @code
2090@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2091@item thread @var{threadno}
2092Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2093argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2094shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2095@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2096you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2097
2098@smallexample
2099@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2100(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2101[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21020x34e5 in sigpause ()
2103@end smallexample
2104
2105@noindent
2106As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2107@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2108threads.
c906108c
SS
2109
2110@kindex thread apply
2111@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2112The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2113more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2114with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2115@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2116threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2117@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2118@end table
2119
2120@cindex automatic thread selection
2121@cindex switching threads automatically
2122@cindex threads, automatic switching
2123Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2124signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2125signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2126message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2127thread.
2128
2129@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2130more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2131programs with multiple threads.
2132
2133@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2134watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2135
6d2ebf8b 2136@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2137@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2138
2139@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2140@cindex multiple processes
2141@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2142On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2143programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2144function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2145parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2146set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2147will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2148will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2149
2150However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2151which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2152the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2153only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2154so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2155on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2156get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2157@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2158the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2159the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2160
53a5351d
JM
2161On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2162debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2163@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2164
2165By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2166the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2167
2168If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2169use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2170
2171@table @code
2172@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2173@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2174Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2175@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2176process. The @var{mode} can be:
2177
2178@table @code
2179@item parent
2180The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2181unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2182
2183@item child
2184The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2185unimpeded.
2186
2187@item ask
2188The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2189@end table
2190
2191@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2192Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2193@end table
2194
2195If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2196@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2197breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2198@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2199the child process's @code{main}.
2200
2201When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2202child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2203
2204If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2205call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2206use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2207argument.
2208
2209You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2210a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2211Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2212
6d2ebf8b 2213@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2214@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2215
2216The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2217program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2218trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2219
7a292a7a
SS
2220Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2221such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2222@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2223change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2224continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2225ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2226explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2227
2228@table @code
2229@kindex info program
2230@item info program
2231Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2232running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2233@end table
2234
2235@menu
2236* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2237* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2238* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2239* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2240@end menu
2241
6d2ebf8b 2242@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2243@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2244
2245@cindex breakpoints
2246A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2247the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2248control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2249breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2250Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2251should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2252program.
2253
2254In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2255breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2256a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2257is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2258not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2259arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2260
2261@cindex watchpoints
2262@cindex memory tracing
2263@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2264@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2265A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2266when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2267command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2268watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2269any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2270and watchpoints using the same commands.
2271
2272You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2273whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2274Automatic display}.
2275
2276@cindex catchpoints
2277@cindex breakpoint on events
2278A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2279when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2280exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2281different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2282catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2283other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2284@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2285
2286@cindex breakpoint numbers
2287@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2288@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2289catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2290starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2291features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2292breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2293@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2294enable it again.
2295
c5394b80
JM
2296@cindex breakpoint ranges
2297@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2298Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2299operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2300@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2301hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2302all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2303
c906108c
SS
2304@menu
2305* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2306* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2307* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2308* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2309* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2310* Conditions:: Break conditions
2311* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2312* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2313* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2314@end menu
2315
6d2ebf8b 2316@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2317@subsection Setting breakpoints
2318
5d161b24 2319@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2320@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2321@c
2322@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2323
2324@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2325@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2326@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2327@cindex latest breakpoint
2328Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2329@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2330number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2331Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2332convenience variables.
2333
2334You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2335
2336@table @code
2337@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2338Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2339When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2340C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2341@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2342
2343@item break +@var{offset}
2344@itemx break -@var{offset}
2345Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2346at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2347(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2348
2349@item break @var{linenum}
2350Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2351The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2352The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2353code on that line.
2354
2355@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2356Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2357
2358@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2359Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2360@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2361superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2362functions.
2363
2364@item break *@var{address}
2365Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2366breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2367information or source files.
2368
2369@item break
2370When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2371the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2372(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2373innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2374returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2375@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2376that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2377@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2378the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2379inside loops.
2380
2381@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2382least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2383would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2384breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2385existed when your program stopped.
2386
2387@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2388Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2389@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2390value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2391@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2392above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2393,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2394
2395@kindex tbreak
2396@item tbreak @var{args}
2397Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2398same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2399way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2400program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2401
c906108c
SS
2402@kindex hbreak
2403@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2404Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2405@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2406breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2407have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2408debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2409changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2410provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2411will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2412address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2413breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2414example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2415@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2416or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2417(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2418
2419@kindex thbreak
2420@item thbreak @var{args}
2421Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2422are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2423the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2424the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2425first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2426command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2427may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2428See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2429
2430@kindex rbreak
2431@cindex regular expression
2432@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2433Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2434@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2435matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2436breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2437the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2438them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2439
2440The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2441like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2442shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2443an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2444@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2445match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2446
b37052ae 2447When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2448breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2449classes.
c906108c
SS
2450
2451@kindex info breakpoints
2452@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2453@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2454@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2455@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2456Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2457not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2458
2459@table @emph
2460@item Breakpoint Numbers
2461@item Type
2462Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2463@item Disposition
2464Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2465@item Enabled or Disabled
2466Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2467that are not enabled.
2468@item Address
2df3850c 2469Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2470@item What
2471Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2472line number.
2473@end table
2474
2475@noindent
2476If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2477the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2478are listed after that.
2479
2480@noindent
2481@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2482number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2483convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2484the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2485listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2486
2487@noindent
2488@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2489has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2490@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2491hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2492was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2493will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2494@end table
2495
2496@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2497your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2498the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2499(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2500
2501@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2502@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2503@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2504purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2505These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2506@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2507
2508You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2509@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2510
2511@table @code
2512@kindex maint info breakpoints
2513@item maint info breakpoints
2514Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2515breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2516internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2517breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2518is shown:
2519
2520@table @code
2521@item breakpoint
2522Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2523
2524@item watchpoint
2525Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2526
2527@item longjmp
2528Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2529@code{longjmp} calls.
2530
2531@item longjmp resume
2532Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2533
2534@item until
2535Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2536
2537@item finish
2538Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2539
c906108c
SS
2540@item shlib events
2541Shared library events.
53a5351d 2542
c906108c 2543@end table
53a5351d 2544
c906108c
SS
2545@end table
2546
2547
6d2ebf8b 2548@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2549@subsection Setting watchpoints
2550
2551@cindex setting watchpoints
2552@cindex software watchpoints
2553@cindex hardware watchpoints
2554You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2555expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2556this may happen.
2557
2558Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2559hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2560program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2561times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2562catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2563culprit.)
2564
d4f3574e 2565On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2566@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2567hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2568program.
2569
2570@table @code
2571@kindex watch
2572@item watch @var{expr}
2573Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2574is written into by the program and its value changes.
2575
2576@kindex rwatch
2577@item rwatch @var{expr}
2578Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2579
2580@kindex awatch
2581@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2582Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2583by the program.
c906108c
SS
2584
2585@kindex info watchpoints
2586@item info watchpoints
2587This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2588it is the same as @code{info break}.
2589@end table
2590
2591@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2592watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2593value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2594cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2595executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2596statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2597
2598When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2599
2600@example
2601Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2602@end example
2603
2604@noindent
2605if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2606
7be570e7
JM
2607Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2608hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2609value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2610every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2611that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2612hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2613will print a message like this:
2614
2615@smallexample
2616Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2617@end smallexample
2618
2619Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2620data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2621watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2622can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2623cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2624double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2625wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2626into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2627
2628If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2629to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2630Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2631time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2632able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2633warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2634
2635@smallexample
2636Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2637@end smallexample
2638
2639@noindent
2640If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2641
2642The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2643or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2644data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2645hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2646both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2647watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2648@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2649watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2650@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2651Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2652
2653If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2654any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2655kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2656
7be570e7
JM
2657@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2658(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2659they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2660which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2661being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2662and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2663rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2664way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2665@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2666
c906108c
SS
2667@quotation
2668@cindex watchpoints and threads
2669@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2670@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2671usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2672can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2673you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2674thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2675can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2676@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2677the expression.
53a5351d 2678
d4f3574e 2679@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2680@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2681have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2682watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2683single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2684change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2685confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2686software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2687when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2688watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2689@end quotation
c906108c 2690
6d2ebf8b 2691@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2692@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2693@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2694@cindex exception handlers
2695@cindex event handling
2696
2697You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2698kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2699shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2700
2701@table @code
2702@kindex catch
2703@item catch @var{event}
2704Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2705@table @code
2706@item throw
2707@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2708The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2709
2710@item catch
2711@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2712The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2713
2714@item exec
2715@kindex catch exec
2716A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2717
2718@item fork
2719@kindex catch fork
2720A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2721
2722@item vfork
2723@kindex catch vfork
2724A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2725
2726@item load
2727@itemx load @var{libname}
2728@kindex catch load
2729The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2730@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2731
2732@item unload
2733@itemx unload @var{libname}
2734@kindex catch unload
2735The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2736of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2737@end table
2738
2739@item tcatch @var{event}
2740Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2741automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2742
2743@end table
2744
2745Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2746
b37052ae 2747There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2748(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2749
2750@itemize @bullet
2751@item
2752If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2753control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2754raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2755returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2756simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2757that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2758you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2759disabled within interactive calls.
2760
2761@item
2762You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2763
2764@item
2765You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2766@end itemize
2767
2768@cindex raise exceptions
2769Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2770if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2771stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2772can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2773breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2774out where the exception was raised.
2775
2776To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2777knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2778raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2779which has the following ANSI C interface:
2780
2781@example
2782 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2783 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2784 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2785@end example
2786
2787@noindent
2788To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2789unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2790(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2791
2792With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2793that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2794a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2795breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2796raised.
2797
2798
6d2ebf8b 2799@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2800@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2801
2802@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2803@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2804It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2805catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2806to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2807breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2808
2809With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2810where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2811delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2812their breakpoint numbers.
2813
2814It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2815automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2816when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2817
2818@table @code
2819@kindex clear
2820@item clear
2821Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2822selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2823the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2824breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2825
2826@item clear @var{function}
2827@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2828Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2829
2830@item clear @var{linenum}
2831@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2832Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2833
2834@cindex delete breakpoints
2835@kindex delete
41afff9a 2836@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2837@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2838Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2839ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2840breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2841confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2842@end table
2843
6d2ebf8b 2844@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2845@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2846
2847@kindex disable breakpoints
2848@kindex enable breakpoints
2849Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2850prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2851it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2852that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2853
2854You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2855the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2856or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2857@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2858catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2859
2860A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2861states of enablement:
2862
2863@itemize @bullet
2864@item
2865Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2866with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2867@item
2868Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2869@item
2870Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2871disabled.
c906108c
SS
2872@item
2873Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2874immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2875set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2876@end itemize
2877
2878You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2879watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2880
2881@table @code
2882@kindex disable breakpoints
2883@kindex disable
41afff9a 2884@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2885@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2886Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2887listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2888options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2889case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2890@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2891
2892@kindex enable breakpoints
2893@kindex enable
c5394b80 2894@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2895Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2896become effective once again in stopping your program.
2897
c5394b80 2898@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2899Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2900of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2901
c5394b80 2902@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2903Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2904deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2905@end table
2906
d4f3574e
SS
2907@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2908@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2909Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2910,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2911subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2912the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2913breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2914breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2915stepping}.)
2916
6d2ebf8b 2917@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2918@subsection Break conditions
2919@cindex conditional breakpoints
2920@cindex breakpoint conditions
2921
2922@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2923@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2924The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2925specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2926breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2927programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2928a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2929and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2930
2931This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2932situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2933when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2934by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2935@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2936
2937Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2938since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2939it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2940and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2941one.
2942
2943Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2944your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2945that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2946format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2947unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2948that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2949program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2950breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2951conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2952purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2953(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2954
2955Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2956@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2957Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2958with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2959
c906108c
SS
2960You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2961The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2962@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2963catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2964
2965@table @code
2966@kindex condition
2967@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2968Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2969watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2970breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2971@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2972@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2973syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2974referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2975symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2976prints an error message:
2977
2978@example
2979No symbol "foo" in current context.
2980@end example
2981
2982@noindent
c906108c
SS
2983@value{GDBN} does
2984not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2985command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2986@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2987
2988@item condition @var{bnum}
2989Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2990an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2991@end table
2992
2993@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2994A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2995breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2996useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2997count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2998is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2999therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3000ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3001the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3002value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3003your program reaches it.
3004
3005@table @code
3006@kindex ignore
3007@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3008Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3009The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3010execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3011takes no action.
3012
3013To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3014a count of zero.
3015
3016When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3017breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3018@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3019Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3020
3021If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3022condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3023@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3024
3025You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3026as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3027is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3028variables}.
3029@end table
3030
3031Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3032
3033
6d2ebf8b 3034@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3035@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3036
3037@cindex breakpoint commands
3038You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3039commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3040example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3041enable other breakpoints.
3042
3043@table @code
3044@kindex commands
3045@kindex end
3046@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3047@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3048@itemx end
3049Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3050themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3051@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3052
3053To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3054follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3055
3056With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3057breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3058recently encountered).
3059@end table
3060
3061Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3062disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3063
3064You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3065use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3066that resumes execution.
3067
3068Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3069execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3070(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3071another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3072ambiguities about which list to execute.
3073
3074@kindex silent
3075If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3076usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3077be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3078then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3079see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3080meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3081
3082The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3083print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3084breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3085
3086For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3087value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3088
3089@example
3090break foo if x>0
3091commands
3092silent
3093printf "x is %d\n",x
3094cont
3095end
3096@end example
3097
3098One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3099you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3100of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3101erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3102to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3103so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3104command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3105
3106@example
3107break 403
3108commands
3109silent
3110set x = y + 4
3111cont
3112end
3113@end example
3114
6d2ebf8b 3115@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3116@subsection Breakpoint menus
3117@cindex overloading
3118@cindex symbol overloading
3119
b37052ae 3120Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3121to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3122This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3123@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3124a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3125something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3126particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3127you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3128waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3129options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3130sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3131@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3132breakpoints.
3133
3134For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3135breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3136We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3137
3138@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3139@smallexample
3140@group
3141(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3142[0] cancel
3143[1] all
3144[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3145[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3146[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3147[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3148[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3149[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3150> 2 4 6
3151Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3152Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3153Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3154Multiple breakpoints were set.
3155Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3156 breakpoints.
3157(@value{GDBP})
3158@end group
3159@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3160
3161@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3162@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3163@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3164@c
3165@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3166@c
d4f3574e
SS
3167Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3168any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3169attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3170@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3171
3172@example
3173Cannot insert breakpoints.
3174The same program may be running in another process.
3175@end example
3176
3177When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3178
3179@enumerate
3180@item
3181Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3182
3183@item
5d161b24 3184Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3185name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3186that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3187Then start your program again.
3188
3189@item
3190Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3191linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3192to nonsharable executables.
3193@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3194@c @end ifclear
3195
d4f3574e
SS
3196A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3197hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3198
3199@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3200@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3201@smallexample
3202Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3203You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3204@end smallexample
3205
3206@noindent
3207This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3208only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3209watchpoints it needs to insert.
3210
3211When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3212hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3213
3214
6d2ebf8b 3215@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3216@section Continuing and stepping
3217
3218@cindex stepping
3219@cindex continuing
3220@cindex resuming execution
3221@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3222completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3223one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3224line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3225particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3226your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3227it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3228@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3229
3230@table @code
3231@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3232@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3233@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3234@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3235@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3236@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3237Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3238any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3239@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3240ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3241@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3242
3243The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3244stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3245@code{continue} is ignored.
3246
d4f3574e
SS
3247The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3248debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3249purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3250@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3251@end table
3252
3253To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3254(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3255calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3256different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3257
3258A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3259(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3260beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3261is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3262and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3263interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3264
3265@table @code
3266@kindex step
41afff9a 3267@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3268@item step
3269Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3270line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3271abbreviated @code{s}.
3272
3273@quotation
3274@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3275@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3276@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3277@c distinction here.
3278@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3279within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3280execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3281debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3282is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3283without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3284below.
3285@end quotation
3286
4a92d011
EZ
3287The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3288line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3289@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3290to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3291the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3292called within the line.
c906108c 3293
d4f3574e
SS
3294Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3295number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3296@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3297on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3298was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3299
3300@item step @var{count}
3301Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3302breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3303@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3304
3305@kindex next
41afff9a 3306@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3307@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3308Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3309This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3310the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3311control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3312that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3313is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3314
3315An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3316
3317
3318@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3319@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3320@c
3321@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3322@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3323@c function are executed without stopping.
3324
d4f3574e
SS
3325The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3326source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3327@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3328
b90a5f51
CF
3329@kindex set step-mode
3330@item set step-mode
3331@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3332@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3333@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3334The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3335stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3336information rather than stepping over it.
3337
4a92d011
EZ
3338This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3339machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3340want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3341
3342@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3343Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3344debug information. This is the default.
3345
c906108c
SS
3346@kindex finish
3347@item finish
3348Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3349returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3350
3351Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3352,Returning from a function}).
3353
3354@kindex until
41afff9a 3355@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3356@item until
3357@itemx u
3358Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3359current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3360stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3361command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3362automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3363than the address of the jump.
3364
3365This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3366though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3367exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3368simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3369through the next iteration.
3370
3371@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3372stack frame.
3373
3374@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3375of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3376example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3377(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3378@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3379
3380@example
3381(@value{GDBP}) f
3382#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3383206 expand_input();
3384(@value{GDBP}) until
3385195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3386@end example
3387
3388This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3389generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3390start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3391written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3392to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3393expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3394statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3395
3396@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3397instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3398argument.
3399
3400@item until @var{location}
3401@itemx u @var{location}
3402Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3403reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3404the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3405,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3406and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3407
3408@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3409@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3410@item stepi
96a2c332 3411@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3412@itemx si
3413Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3414
3415It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3416instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3417instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3418Display,, Automatic display}.
3419
3420An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3421
3422@need 750
3423@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3424@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3425@item nexti
96a2c332 3426@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3427@itemx ni
3428Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3429proceed until the function returns.
3430
3431An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3432@end table
3433
6d2ebf8b 3434@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3435@section Signals
3436@cindex signals
3437
3438A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3439operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3440kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3441signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3442@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3443memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3444the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3445requested an alarm).
3446
3447@cindex fatal signals
3448Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3449functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3450errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3451program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3452@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3453fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3454
3455@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3456program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3457signal.
3458
3459@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3460Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3461@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3462(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3463but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3464You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3465
3466@table @code
3467@kindex info signals
3468@item info signals
96a2c332 3469@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3470Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3471handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3472the defined types of signals.
3473
d4f3574e 3474@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3475
3476@kindex handle
3477@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3478Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3479can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3480@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3481@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3482known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3483@end table
3484
3485@c @group
3486The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3487Their full names are:
3488
3489@table @code
3490@item nostop
3491@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3492still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3493
3494@item stop
3495@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3496the @code{print} keyword as well.
3497
3498@item print
3499@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3500
3501@item noprint
3502@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3503implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3504
3505@item pass
5ece1a18 3506@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3507@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3508can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3509and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3510
3511@item nopass
5ece1a18 3512@itemx ignore
c906108c 3513@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3514@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3515@end table
3516@c @end group
3517
d4f3574e
SS
3518When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3519program until you
c906108c
SS
3520continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3521effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3522after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3523command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3524program sees that signal when you continue.
3525
24f93129
EZ
3526The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3527non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3528@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3529erroneous signals.
3530
c906108c
SS
3531You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3532seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3533or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3534due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3535values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3536execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3537a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3538you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3539program a signal}.
c906108c 3540
6d2ebf8b 3541@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3542@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3543
3544When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3545programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3546breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3547
3548@table @code
3549@cindex breakpoints and threads
3550@cindex thread breakpoints
3551@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3552@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3553@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3554@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3555writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3556
3557Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3558to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3559particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3560numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3561column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3562
3563If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3564breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3565program.
3566
3567You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3568well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3569breakpoint condition, like this:
3570
3571@smallexample
2df3850c 3572(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3573@end smallexample
3574
3575@end table
3576
3577@cindex stopped threads
3578@cindex threads, stopped
3579Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3580@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3581allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3582switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3583underfoot.
3584
3585@cindex continuing threads
3586@cindex threads, continuing
3587Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3588executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3589like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3590
3591In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3592Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3593system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3594execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3595single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3596statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3597stops.
3598
3599You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3600continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3601thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3602first thread completes whatever you requested.
3603
3604On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3605thread to run.
3606
3607@table @code
3608@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3609Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3610locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3611current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3612mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3613``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3614stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3615when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3616function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3617like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3618thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3619@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3620
3621@item show scheduler-locking
3622Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3623@end table
3624
c906108c 3625
6d2ebf8b 3626@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3627@chapter Examining the Stack
3628
3629When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3630stopped and how it got there.
3631
3632@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3633Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3634is generated.
3635That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3636the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3637and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3638The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3639The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3640stack}.
3641
3642When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3643stack allow you to see all of this information.
3644
3645@cindex selected frame
3646One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3647@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3648particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3649your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3650special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3651interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3652
3653When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3654currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3655@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3656
3657@menu
3658* Frames:: Stack frames
3659* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3660* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3661* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3662
3663@end menu
3664
6d2ebf8b 3665@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3666@section Stack frames
3667
d4f3574e 3668@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3669@cindex stack frame
3670The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3671frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3672with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3673to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3674which the function is executing.
3675
3676@cindex initial frame
3677@cindex outermost frame
3678@cindex innermost frame
3679When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3680function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3681@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3682made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3683is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3684the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3685actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3686recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3687
3688@cindex frame pointer
3689Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3690stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3691kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3692address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3693in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3694going on in that frame.
3695
3696@cindex frame number
3697@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3698zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3699and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3700they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3701frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3702
6d2ebf8b
SS
3703@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3704@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3705@cindex frameless execution
3706Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3707without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3708@example
3709@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3710@end example
3711generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3712This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3713the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3714with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3715has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3716it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3717correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3718no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3719
3720@table @code
d4f3574e 3721@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3722@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3723@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3724The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3725and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3726address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3727@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3728
3729@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3730@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3731@item select-frame
3732The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3733to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3734@code{frame}.
3735@end table
3736
6d2ebf8b 3737@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3738@section Backtraces
3739
3740@cindex backtraces
3741@cindex tracebacks
3742@cindex stack traces
3743A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3744line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3745frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3746stack.
3747
3748@table @code
3749@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3750@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3751@item backtrace
3752@itemx bt
3753Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3754frames in the stack.
3755
3756You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3757character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3758
3759@item backtrace @var{n}
3760@itemx bt @var{n}
3761Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3762
3763@item backtrace -@var{n}
3764@itemx bt -@var{n}
3765Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3766@end table
3767
3768@kindex where
3769@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3770@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3771The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3772are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3773
3774Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3775The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3776print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3777line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3778counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3779line number.
3780
3781Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3782@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3783
3784@smallexample
3785@group
5d161b24 3786#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3787 at builtin.c:993
3788#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3789#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3790 at macro.c:71
3791(More stack frames follow...)
3792@end group
3793@end smallexample
3794
3795@noindent
3796The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3797value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3798code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3799
6d2ebf8b 3800@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3801@section Selecting a frame
3802
3803Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3804whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3805selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3806of the stack frame just selected.
3807
3808@table @code
d4f3574e 3809@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3810@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3811@item frame @var{n}
3812@itemx f @var{n}
3813Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3814(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3815innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3816@code{main}.
3817
3818@item frame @var{addr}
3819@itemx f @var{addr}
3820Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3821chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3822impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3823addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3824switches between them.
3825
c906108c
SS
3826On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3827select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3828
3829On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3830pointer and a program counter.
3831
3832On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3833pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3834@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3835@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3836@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3837
3838@kindex up
3839@item up @var{n}
3840Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3841advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3842that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3843
3844@kindex down
41afff9a 3845@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3846@item down @var{n}
3847Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3848advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3849that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3850abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3851@end table
3852
3853All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3854frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3855arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3856frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3857
3858@need 1000
3859For example:
3860
3861@smallexample
3862@group
3863(@value{GDBP}) up
3864#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3865 at env.c:10
386610 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3867@end group
3868@end smallexample
3869
3870After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3871prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3872@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3873
3874@table @code
3875@kindex down-silently
3876@kindex up-silently
3877@item up-silently @var{n}
3878@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3879These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3880respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3881causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3882in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3883distracting.
3884@end table
3885
6d2ebf8b 3886@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3887@section Information about a frame
3888
3889There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3890stack frame.
3891
3892@table @code
3893@item frame
3894@itemx f
3895When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3896frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3897selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3898argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3899@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3900
3901@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3902@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3903@item info frame
3904@itemx info f
3905This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3906including:
3907
3908@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3909@item
3910the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3911@item
3912the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3913@item
3914the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3915@item
3916the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3917@item
3918the address of the frame's arguments
3919@item
d4f3574e
SS
3920the address of the frame's local variables
3921@item
c906108c
SS
3922the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3923@item
3924which registers were saved in the frame
3925@end itemize
3926
3927@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3928something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3929the usual conventions.
3930
3931@item info frame @var{addr}
3932@itemx info f @var{addr}
3933Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3934selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3935command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3936architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3937@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3938
3939@kindex info args
3940@item info args
3941Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3942
3943@item info locals
3944@kindex info locals
3945Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3946line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3947accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3948
c906108c 3949@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3950@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3951@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3952@item info catch
3953Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3954current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3955exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3956@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3957@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3958
c906108c
SS
3959@end table
3960
c906108c 3961
6d2ebf8b 3962@node Source
c906108c
SS
3963@chapter Examining Source Files
3964
3965@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3966information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3967used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3968the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3969(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3970execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3971source files by explicit command.
3972
7a292a7a 3973If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3974prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3975@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3976
3977@menu
3978* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3979* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3980* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3981* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3982@end menu
3983
6d2ebf8b 3984@node List
c906108c
SS
3985@section Printing source lines
3986
3987@kindex list
41afff9a 3988@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 3989To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 3990(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
3991There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3992
3993Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3994
3995@table @code
3996@item list @var{linenum}
3997Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3998current source file.
3999
4000@item list @var{function}
4001Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4002@var{function}.
4003
4004@item list
4005Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4006@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4007printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4008as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4009Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4010
4011@item list -
4012Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4013@end table
4014
4015By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4016the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4017
4018@table @code
4019@kindex set listsize
4020@item set listsize @var{count}
4021Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4022the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4023
4024@kindex show listsize
4025@item show listsize
4026Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4027@end table
4028
4029Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4030so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4031than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4032argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4033each repetition moves up in the source file.
4034
4035@cindex linespec
4036In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4037@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4038of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4039Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4040
4041@table @code
4042@item list @var{linespec}
4043Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4044
4045@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4046Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4047linespecs.
4048
4049@item list ,@var{last}
4050Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4051
4052@item list @var{first},
4053Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4054
4055@item list +
4056Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4057
4058@item list -
4059Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4060
4061@item list
4062As described in the preceding table.
4063@end table
4064
4065Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4066kinds of linespec.
4067
4068@table @code
4069@item @var{number}
4070Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4071When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4072the same source file as the first linespec.
4073
4074@item +@var{offset}
4075Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4076When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4077two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4078first linespec.
4079
4080@item -@var{offset}
4081Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4082
4083@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4084Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4085
4086@item @var{function}
4087Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4088For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4089
4090@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4091Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4092function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4093file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4094identically named functions in different source files.
4095
4096@item *@var{address}
4097Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4098@var{address} may be any expression.
4099@end table
4100
6d2ebf8b 4101@node Search
c906108c
SS
4102@section Searching source files
4103@cindex searching
4104@kindex reverse-search
4105
4106There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4107regular expression.
4108
4109@table @code
4110@kindex search
4111@kindex forward-search
4112@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4113@itemx search @var{regexp}
4114The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4115starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4116@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4117synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4118@code{fo}.
4119
4120@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4121The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4122with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4123for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4124this command as @code{rev}.
4125@end table
c906108c 4126
6d2ebf8b 4127@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4128@section Specifying source directories
4129
4130@cindex source path
4131@cindex directories for source files
4132Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4133files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4134the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4135session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4136this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4137it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4138in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4139the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4140the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4141path.
4142
4143If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4144object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4145too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4146compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4147last resort.
4148
4149Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4150any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4151each line is in the file.
4152
4153@kindex directory
4154@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4155When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4156and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4157To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4158
4159@table @code
4160@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4161@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4162Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4163directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4164(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4165part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4166whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4167path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4168
4169@kindex cdir
4170@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4171@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4172@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4173@cindex compilation directory
4174@cindex current directory
4175@cindex working directory
4176@cindex directory, current
4177@cindex directory, compilation
4178You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4179directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4180working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4181tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4182session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4183directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4184
4185@item directory
4186Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4187
4188@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4189@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4190
4191@item show directories
4192@kindex show directories
4193Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4194@end table
4195
4196If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4197interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4198versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4199
4200@enumerate
4201@item
4202Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4203
4204@item
4205Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4206directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4207directories in one command.
4208@end enumerate
4209
6d2ebf8b 4210@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4211@section Source and machine code
4212
4213You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4214addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4215a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4216mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4217line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4218well as hex.
4219
4220@table @code
4221@kindex info line
4222@item info line @var{linespec}
4223Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4224source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4225the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4226source lines}).
4227@end table
4228
4229For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4230the object code for the first line of function
4231@code{m4_changequote}:
4232
d4f3574e
SS
4233@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4234@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4235@smallexample
96a2c332 4236(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4237Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4238@end smallexample
4239
4240@noindent
4241We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4242@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4243@smallexample
4244(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4245Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4246@end smallexample
4247
4248@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4249@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4250After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4251is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4252sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4253,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4254convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4255variables}).
4256
4257@table @code
4258@kindex disassemble
4259@cindex assembly instructions
4260@cindex instructions, assembly
4261@cindex machine instructions
4262@cindex listing machine instructions
4263@item disassemble
4264This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4265instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4266program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4267command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4268surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4269(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4270@end table
4271
c906108c
SS
4272The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4273HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4274
4275@smallexample
4276(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4277Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42780x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42790x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
42800x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
42810x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
42820x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
42830x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
42840x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
42850x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4286End of assembler dump.
4287@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4288
4289Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4290mnemonics or other syntax.
4291
4292@table @code
d4f3574e 4293@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4294@cindex assembly instructions
4295@cindex instructions, assembly
4296@cindex machine instructions
4297@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4298@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4299@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4300@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4301Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4302program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4303
4304Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4305can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4306The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4307assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4308@end table
4309
4310
6d2ebf8b 4311@node Data
c906108c
SS
4312@chapter Examining Data
4313
4314@cindex printing data
4315@cindex examining data
4316@kindex print
4317@kindex inspect
4318@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4319@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4320@c different window or something like that.
4321The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4322command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4323evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4324program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4325Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4326
4327@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4328@item print @var{expr}
4329@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4330@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4331value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4332you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4333@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4334formats}.
4335
4336@item print
4337@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4338If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4339@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4340conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4341@end table
4342
4343A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4344It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4345specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4346
7a292a7a 4347If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4348fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4349command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4350Table}.
c906108c
SS
4351
4352@menu
4353* Expressions:: Expressions
4354* Variables:: Program variables
4355* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4356* Output Formats:: Output formats
4357* Memory:: Examining memory
4358* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4359* Print Settings:: Print settings
4360* Value History:: Value history
4361* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4362* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4363* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4364* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4365@end menu
4366
6d2ebf8b 4367@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4368@section Expressions
4369
4370@cindex expressions
4371@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4372compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4373by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4374@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4375and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4376by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4377
d4f3574e
SS
4378@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4379the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4380you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4381memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4382
c906108c
SS
4383Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4384this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4385Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4386languages.
4387
4388In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4389expressions regardless of your programming language.
4390
4391Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4392useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4393at that address in memory.
4394@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4395
4396@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4397to programming languages:
4398
4399@table @code
4400@item @@
4401@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4402@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4403
4404@item ::
4405@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4406function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4407
4408@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4409@cindex type casting memory
4410@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4411@cindex casts, to view memory
4412@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4413Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4414memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4415pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4416a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4417normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4418@end table
4419
6d2ebf8b 4420@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4421@section Program variables
4422
4423The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4424in your program.
4425
4426Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4427(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4428
4429@itemize @bullet
4430@item
4431global (or file-static)
4432@end itemize
4433
5d161b24 4434@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4435
4436@itemize @bullet
4437@item
4438visible according to the scope rules of the
4439programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4440@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4441
4442@noindent This means that in the function
4443
4444@example
4445foo (a)
4446 int a;
4447@{
4448 bar (a);
4449 @{
4450 int b = test ();
4451 bar (b);
4452 @}
4453@}
4454@end example
4455
4456@noindent
4457you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4458executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4459examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4460the block where @code{b} is declared.
4461
4462@cindex variable name conflict
4463There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4464scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4465in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4466function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4467happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4468you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4469using the colon-colon notation:
4470
d4f3574e 4471@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4472@iftex
4473@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4474@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4475@end iftex
4476@example
4477@var{file}::@var{variable}
4478@var{function}::@var{variable}
4479@end example
4480
4481@noindent
4482Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4483static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4484make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4485to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4486
4487@example
4488(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4489@end example
4490
b37052ae 4491@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4492This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4493use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4494scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4495@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4496@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4497
4498@cindex wrong values
4499@cindex variable values, wrong
4500@quotation
4501@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4502wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4503scope, and just before exit.
4504@end quotation
4505You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4506This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4507set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4508stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4509values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4510also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4511after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4512variable definitions may be gone.
4513
4514This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4515To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4516when compiling.
4517
d4f3574e
SS
4518@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4519Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4520unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4521opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4522offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4523might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4524happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4525
4526@example
4527No symbol "foo" in current context.
4528@end example
4529
4530To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4531different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4532formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4533supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4534in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4535to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4536debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4537Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4538information.
4539
4540
6d2ebf8b 4541@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4542@section Artificial arrays
4543
4544@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4545@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4546It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4547same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4548dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4549program.
4550
4551You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4552@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4553operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4554and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4555of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4556the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4557argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4558following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4559example. If a program says
4560
4561@example
4562int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4563@end example
4564
4565@noindent
4566you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4567
4568@example
4569p *array@@len
4570@end example
4571
4572The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4573with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4574subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4575Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4576(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4577
4578Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4579This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4580The value need not be in memory:
4581@example
4582(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4583$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4584@end example
4585
4586As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4587@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4588the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4589@example
4590(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4591$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4592@end example
4593
4594Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4595moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4596actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4597of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4598to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4599variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4600interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4601instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4602structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4603in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4604
4605@example
4606set $i = 0
4607p dtab[$i++]->fv
4608@key{RET}
4609@key{RET}
4610@dots{}
4611@end example
4612
6d2ebf8b 4613@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4614@section Output formats
4615
4616@cindex formatted output
4617@cindex output formats
4618By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4619this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4620in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4621at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4622these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4623
4624The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4625already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4626@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4627letters supported are:
4628
4629@table @code
4630@item x
4631Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4632hexadecimal.
4633
4634@item d
4635Print as integer in signed decimal.
4636
4637@item u
4638Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4639
4640@item o
4641Print as integer in octal.
4642
4643@item t
4644Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4645@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4646used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4647see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4648
4649@item a
4650@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4651@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4652Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4653the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4654where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4655
4656@example
4657(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4658$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4659@end example
4660
3d67e040
EZ
4661@noindent
4662The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4663@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4664
c906108c
SS
4665@item c
4666Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4667
4668@item f
4669Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4670using typical floating point syntax.
4671@end table
4672
4673For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4674
4675@example
4676p/x $pc
4677@end example
4678
4679@noindent
4680Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4681names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4682
4683To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4684you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4685expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4686
6d2ebf8b 4687@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4688@section Examining memory
4689
4690You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4691any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4692
4693@cindex examining memory
4694@table @code
41afff9a 4695@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4696@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4697@itemx x @var{addr}
4698@itemx x
4699Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4700@end table
4701
4702@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4703much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4704expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4705If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4706Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4707
4708@table @r
4709@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4710The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4711how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4712@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4713@c 4.1.2.
4714
4715@item @var{f}, the display format
4716The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4717@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4718The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4719The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4720
4721@item @var{u}, the unit size
4722The unit size is any of
4723
4724@table @code
4725@item b
4726Bytes.
4727@item h
4728Halfwords (two bytes).
4729@item w
4730Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4731@item g
4732Giant words (eight bytes).
4733@end table
4734
4735Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4736default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4737@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4738
4739@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4740@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4741memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4742it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4743@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4744@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4745other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4746the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4747starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4748a value from memory).
4749@end table
4750
4751For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4752(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4753starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4754words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4755@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4756
4757Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4758letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4759unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4760specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4761(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4762
4763Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4764and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4765@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4766including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4767alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4768Code,,Source and machine code}.
4769
4770All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4771easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4772you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4773instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4774with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4775the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4776for successive uses of @code{x}.
4777
4778@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4779The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4780in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4781would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4782subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4783@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4784examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4785@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4786the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4787
4788If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4789are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4790address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4791
6d2ebf8b 4792@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4793@section Automatic display
4794@cindex automatic display
4795@cindex display of expressions
4796
4797If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4798(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4799display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4800Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4801to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4802The automatic display looks like this:
4803
4804@example
48052: foo = 38
48063: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4807@end example
4808
4809@noindent
4810This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4811displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4812specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4813whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4814format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4815or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4816supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4817
4818@table @code
4819@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4820@item display @var{expr}
4821Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4822each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4823
4824@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4825
d4f3574e 4826@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4827For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4828count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4829arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4830@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4831
4832@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4833For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4834number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4835be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4836doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4837@end table
4838
4839For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4840instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4841is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4842
4843@table @code
4844@kindex delete display
4845@kindex undisplay
4846@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4847@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4848Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4849
4850@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4851(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4852
4853@kindex disable display
4854@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4855Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4856item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4857enabled again later.
4858
4859@kindex enable display
4860@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4861Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4862again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4863
4864@item display
4865Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4866done when your program stops.
4867
4868@kindex info display
4869@item info display
4870Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4871automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4872values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4873It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4874because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4875@end table
4876
4877If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4878sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4879expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4880variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4881@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4882@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4883continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4884there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4885automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4886is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4887
6d2ebf8b 4888@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4889@section Print settings
4890
4891@cindex format options
4892@cindex print settings
4893@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4894and symbols are printed.
4895
4896@noindent
4897These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4898
4899@table @code
4900@kindex set print address
4901@item set print address
4902@itemx set print address on
4903@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4904traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4905even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4906is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4907@code{set print address on}:
4908
4909@smallexample
4910@group
4911(@value{GDBP}) f
4912#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4913 at input.c:530
4914530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4915@end group
4916@end smallexample
4917
4918@item set print address off
4919Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4920this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4921
4922@smallexample
4923@group
4924(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4925(@value{GDBP}) f
4926#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4927530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4928@end group
4929@end smallexample
4930
4931You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4932dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4933@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4934all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4935
4936@kindex show print address
4937@item show print address
4938Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4939@end table
4940
4941When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4942closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4943identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4944source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4945@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4946you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4947it prints a symbolic address:
4948
4949@table @code
4950@kindex set print symbol-filename
4951@item set print symbol-filename on
4952Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4953symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4954
4955@item set print symbol-filename off
4956Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4957default.
4958
4959@kindex show print symbol-filename
4960@item show print symbol-filename
4961Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4962line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4963@end table
4964
4965Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4966numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4967number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4968
4969Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4970printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4971
4972@table @code
4973@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4974@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4975Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4976offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4977@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4978to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4979
4980@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4981@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4982Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4983symbolic address.
4984@end table
4985
4986@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4987@cindex pointer, finding referent
4988If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4989@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4990and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4991@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4992For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4993at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4994
4995@example
4996(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4997(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4998$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4999@end example
5000
5001@quotation
5002@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5003does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5004the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5005@end quotation
5006
5007Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5008
5009@table @code
5010@kindex set print array
5011@item set print array
5012@itemx set print array on
5013Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5014but uses more space. The default is off.
5015
5016@item set print array off
5017Return to compressed format for arrays.
5018
5019@kindex show print array
5020@item show print array
5021Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5022arrays.
5023
5024@kindex set print elements
5025@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5026Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5027If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5028printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5029This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5030When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5031Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5032
5033@kindex show print elements
5034@item show print elements
5035Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5036If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5037
5038@kindex set print null-stop
5039@item set print null-stop
5040Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5041@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5042contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5043The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5044
5045@kindex set print pretty
5046@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5047Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5048per line, like this:
5049
5050@smallexample
5051@group
5052$1 = @{
5053 next = 0x0,
5054 flags = @{
5055 sweet = 1,
5056 sour = 1
5057 @},
5058 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5059@}
5060@end group
5061@end smallexample
5062
5063@item set print pretty off
5064Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5065
5066@smallexample
5067@group
5068$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5069meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5070@end group
5071@end smallexample
5072
5073@noindent
5074This is the default format.
5075
5076@kindex show print pretty
5077@item show print pretty
5078Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5079
5080@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5081@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5082Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5083@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5084character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5085best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5086high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5087
5088@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5089Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5090international character sets, and is the default.
5091
5092@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5093@item show print sevenbit-strings
5094Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5095
5096@kindex set print union
5097@item set print union on
5d161b24 5098Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5099is the default setting.
5100
5101@item set print union off
5102Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5103
5104@kindex show print union
5105@item show print union
5106Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5107structures.
5108
5109For example, given the declarations
5110
5111@smallexample
5112typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5113typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5114typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5115 Bug_forms;
5116
5117struct thing @{
5118 Species it;
5119 union @{
5120 Tree_forms tree;
5121 Bug_forms bug;
5122 @} form;
5123@};
5124
5125struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5126@end smallexample
5127
5128@noindent
5129with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5130
5131@smallexample
5132$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5133@end smallexample
5134
5135@noindent
5136and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5137
5138@smallexample
5139$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5140@end smallexample
5141@end table
5142
c906108c
SS
5143@need 1000
5144@noindent
b37052ae 5145These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5146
5147@table @code
5148@cindex demangling
5149@kindex set print demangle
5150@item set print demangle
5151@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5152Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5153(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5154linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5155
5156@kindex show print demangle
5157@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5158Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5159
5160@kindex set print asm-demangle
5161@item set print asm-demangle
5162@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5163Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5164in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5165The default is off.
5166
5167@kindex show print asm-demangle
5168@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5169Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5170or demangled form.
5171
5172@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5173@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5174@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5175@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5176Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5177represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5178
5179@table @code
5180@item auto
5181Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5182
5183@item gnu
b37052ae 5184Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5185This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5186
5187@item hp
b37052ae 5188Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5189
5190@item lucid
b37052ae 5191Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5192
5193@item arm
b37052ae 5194Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5195@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5196debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5197require further enhancement to permit that.
5198
5199@end table
5200If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5201
5202@kindex show demangle-style
5203@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5204Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5205
5206@kindex set print object
5207@item set print object
5208@itemx set print object on
5209When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5210(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5211the virtual function table.
5212
5213@item set print object off
5214Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5215virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5216
5217@kindex show print object
5218@item show print object
5219Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5220
5221@kindex set print static-members
5222@item set print static-members
5223@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5224Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5225
5226@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5227Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5228
5229@kindex show print static-members
5230@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5231Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5232
5233@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5234@kindex set print vtbl
5235@item set print vtbl
5236@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5237Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5238(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5239ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5240
5241@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5242Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5243
5244@kindex show print vtbl
5245@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5246Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5247@end table
c906108c 5248
6d2ebf8b 5249@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5250@section Value history
5251
5252@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5253Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5254@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5255Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5256(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5257When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5258since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5259symbol table.
5260
5261@cindex @code{$}
5262@cindex @code{$$}
5263@cindex history number
5264The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5265refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5266@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5267printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5268history number.
5269
5270To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5271history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5272remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5273the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5274@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5275is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5276@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5277
5278For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5279want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5280
5281@example
5282p *$
5283@end example
5284
5285If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5286to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5287
5288@example
5289p *$.next
5290@end example
5291
5292@noindent
5293You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5294command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5295
5296Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5297@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5298
5299@example
5300print x
5301set x=5
5302@end example
5303
5304@noindent
5305then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5306remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5307
5308@table @code
5309@kindex show values
5310@item show values
5311Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5312This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5313values} does not change the history.
5314
5315@item show values @var{n}
5316Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5317
5318@item show values +
5319Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5320values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5321@end table
5322
5323Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5324same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5325
6d2ebf8b 5326@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5327@section Convenience variables
5328
5329@cindex convenience variables
5330@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5331@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5332exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5333setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5334of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5335
5336Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5337@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5338the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5339(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5340by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5341
5342You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5343expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5344For example:
5345
5346@example
5347set $foo = *object_ptr
5348@end example
5349
5350@noindent
5351would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5352@code{object_ptr}.
5353
5354Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5355value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5356value with another assignment at any time.
5357
5358Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5359variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5360that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5361variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5362
5363@table @code
5364@kindex show convenience
5365@item show convenience
5366Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5367Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5368@end table
5369
5370One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5371incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5372a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5373
5374@example
5375set $i = 0
5376print bar[$i++]->contents
5377@end example
5378
d4f3574e
SS
5379@noindent
5380Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5381
5382Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5383values likely to be useful.
5384
5385@table @code
41afff9a 5386@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5387@item $_
5388The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5389the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5390commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5391set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5392and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5393except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5394to the type of @code{$__}.
5395
41afff9a 5396@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5397@item $__
5398The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5399to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5400to match the format in which the data was printed.
5401
5402@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5403@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5404The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5405the program being debugged terminates.
5406@end table
5407
53a5351d
JM
5408On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5409begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5410name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5411
6d2ebf8b 5412@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5413@section Registers
5414
5415@cindex registers
5416You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5417with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5418for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5419your machine.
5420
5421@table @code
5422@kindex info registers
5423@item info registers
5424Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5425registers (in the selected stack frame).
5426
5427@kindex info all-registers
5428@cindex floating point registers
5429@item info all-registers
5430Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5431registers.
5432
5433@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5434Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5435As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5436the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5437the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5438@end table
5439
5440@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5441expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5442architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5443@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5444the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5445pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5446register that contains the processor status. For example,
5447you could print the program counter in hex with
5448
5449@example
5450p/x $pc
5451@end example
5452
5453@noindent
5454or print the instruction to be executed next with
5455
5456@example
5457x/i $pc
5458@end example
5459
5460@noindent
5461or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5462one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5463memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5464stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5465stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5466regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5467see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5468
5469@example
5470set $sp += 4
5471@end example
5472
5473Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5474your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5475so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5476shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5477registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5478can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5479is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5480
5481@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5482integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5483special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5484registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5485to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5486(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5487@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5488
5489Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5490means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5491the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5492sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5493coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5494programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5495cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5496that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5497prints the data in both formats.
5498
5499Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5500(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5501value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5502were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5503true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5504frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5505
5506However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5507code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5508@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5509frame makes no difference.
5510
6d2ebf8b 5511@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5512@section Floating point hardware
5513@cindex floating point
5514
5515Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5516you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5517
5518@table @code
5519@kindex info float
5520@item info float
5521Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5522point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5523floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5524the ARM and x86 machines.
5525@end table
c906108c 5526
29e57380
C
5527@node Memory Region Attributes
5528@section Memory Region Attributes
5529@cindex memory region attributes
5530
5531@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5532required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5533to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5534use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5535
5536Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5537memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5538accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5539been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5540all memory.
5541
5542When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5543to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5544
5545@table @code
5546@kindex mem
5547@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5548Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5549with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5550
5551@kindex delete mem
5552@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5553Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5554
5555@kindex disable mem
5556@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5557Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5558A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5559It may be enabled again later.
5560
5561@kindex enable mem
5562@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5563Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5564
5565@kindex info mem
5566@item info mem
5567Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5568for each region.
5569
5570@table @emph
5571@item Memory Region Number
5572@item Enabled or Disabled.
5573Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5574Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5575
5576@item Lo Address
5577The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5578
5579@item Hi Address
5580The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5581
5582@item Attributes
5583The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5584@end table
5585@end table
5586
5587
5588@subsection Attributes
5589
5590@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5591The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5592write accesses to a memory region.
5593
5594While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5595memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5596etc. from accessing memory.
5597
5598@table @code
5599@item ro
5600Memory is read only.
5601@item wo
5602Memory is write only.
5603@item rw
5604Memory is read/write (default).
5605@end table
5606
5607@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5608The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5609accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5610require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5611specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5612
5613@table @code
5614@item 8
5615Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5616@item 16
5617Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5618@item 32
5619Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5620@item 64
5621Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5622@end table
5623
5624@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5625@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5626@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5627@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5628@c
5629@c @table @code
5630@c @item hwbreak
5631@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5632@c @item swbreak (default)
5633@c @end table
5634
5635@subsubsection Data Cache
5636The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5637memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5638protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5639does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5640registers.
5641
5642@table @code
5643@item cache
5644Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5645@item nocache (default)
5646Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5647@end table
5648
5649@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5650@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5651@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5652@c
5653@c @table @code
5654@c @item verify
5655@c @item noverify (default)
5656@c @end table
5657
b37052ae
EZ
5658@node Tracepoints
5659@chapter Tracepoints
5660@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5661@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5662
5663@cindex tracepoints
5664In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5665the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5666anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5667depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5668might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5669fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5670to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5671
5672Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5673specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5674arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5675Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5676those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5677expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5678for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5679a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5680in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5681values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5682unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5683
5684The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5685targets. @xref{Targets}.
5686
5687This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5688
5689@menu
5690* Set Tracepoints::
5691* Analyze Collected Data::
5692* Tracepoint Variables::
5693@end menu
5694
5695@node Set Tracepoints
5696@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5697
5698Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5699tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5700tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5701breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5702one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5703tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5704work on.
5705
5706For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5707of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5708it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5709local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5710commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5711tracepoint was hit.
5712
5713This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5714conditions and actions.
5715
5716@menu
5717* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5718* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5719* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5720* Tracepoint Actions::
5721* Listing Tracepoints::
5722* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5723@end menu
5724
5725@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5726@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5727
5728@table @code
5729@cindex set tracepoint
5730@kindex trace
5731@item trace
5732The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5733Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5734the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5735defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5736debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5737program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5738doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5739cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5740running.
5741
5742Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5743
5744@smallexample
5745(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5746
5747(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5748
5749(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5750
5751(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5752
5753(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5754@end smallexample
5755
5756@noindent
5757You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5758
5759@vindex $tpnum
5760@cindex last tracepoint number
5761@cindex recent tracepoint number
5762@cindex tracepoint number
5763The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5764of the most recently set tracepoint.
5765
5766@kindex delete tracepoint
5767@cindex tracepoint deletion
5768@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5769Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5770default is to delete all tracepoints.
5771
5772Examples:
5773
5774@smallexample
5775(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5776
5777(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5778@end smallexample
5779
5780@noindent
5781You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5782@end table
5783
5784@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5785@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5786
5787@table @code
5788@kindex disable tracepoint
5789@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5790Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5791@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5792the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5793a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5794
5795@kindex enable tracepoint
5796@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5797Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5798tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5799run.
5800@end table
5801
5802@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5803@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5804
5805@table @code
5806@kindex passcount
5807@cindex tracepoint pass count
5808@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5809Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5810automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5811@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5812the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5813@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5814passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5815given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5816user.
5817
5818Examples:
5819
5820@smallexample
5821(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of tracepoint 2
5822
5823(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5824 // most recently defined tracepoint.
5825(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5826(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5827(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5828(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5829(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5830(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5831 // executed 3 times OR when bar has
5832 // been executed 2 times
5833 // OR when baz has been executed 1 time.
5834@end smallexample
5835@end table
5836
5837@node Tracepoint Actions
5838@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5839
5840@table @code
5841@kindex actions
5842@cindex tracepoint actions
5843@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5844This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5845tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5846specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5847recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5848@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5849actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5850terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5851far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5852@code{while-stepping}.
5853
5854@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5855To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5856and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5857
5858@smallexample
5859(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5860
5861(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times and collect data
5862
5863(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5864@end smallexample
5865
5866In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5867commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5868hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5869following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5870followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5871@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5872@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5873@code{end} command.
5874
5875@smallexample
5876(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5877(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5878Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5879> collect bar,baz
5880> collect $regs
5881> while-stepping 12
5882 > collect $fp, $sp
5883 > end
5884end
5885@end smallexample
5886
5887@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5888@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5889Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5890This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5891In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5892special arguments are supported:
5893
5894@table @code
5895@item $regs
5896collect all registers
5897
5898@item $args
5899collect all function arguments
5900
5901@item $locals
5902collect all local variables.
5903@end table
5904
5905You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5906with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5907arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5908
f5c37c66
EZ
5909The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
5910particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
5911
b37052ae
EZ
5912@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5913@item while-stepping @var{n}
5914Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5915new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
5916followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5917its own @code{end} command):
5918
5919@smallexample
5920> while-stepping 12
5921 > collect $regs, myglobal
5922 > end
5923>
5924@end smallexample
5925
5926@noindent
5927You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5928@code{stepping}.
5929@end table
5930
5931@node Listing Tracepoints
5932@subsection Listing Tracepoints
5933
5934@table @code
5935@kindex info tracepoints
5936@cindex information about tracepoints
5937@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5938Display information the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify a
5939tracepoint number displays information about all the tracepoints
5940defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
5941shown:
5942
5943@itemize @bullet
5944@item
5945its number
5946@item
5947whether it is enabled or disabled
5948@item
5949its address
5950@item
5951its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5952@item
5953its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5954@item
5955where in the source files is the tracepoint set
5956@item
5957its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
5958@end itemize
5959
5960@smallexample
5961(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
5962Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
59631 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
59642 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in gdb_test at gdb_test.c:375
59653 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in collect_data at ../foo.c:1741
5966(@value{GDBP})
5967@end smallexample
5968
5969@noindent
5970This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
5971@end table
5972
5973@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5974@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5975
5976@table @code
5977@kindex tstart
5978@cindex start a new trace experiment
5979@cindex collected data discarded
5980@item tstart
5981This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
5982begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
5983the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
5984experiment.
5985
5986@kindex tstop
5987@cindex stop a running trace experiment
5988@item tstop
5989This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
5990stops collecting data.
5991
5992@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
5993automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
5994(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
5995
5996@kindex tstatus
5997@cindex status of trace data collection
5998@cindex trace experiment, status of
5999@item tstatus
6000This command displays the status of the current trace data
6001collection.
6002@end table
6003
6004Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6005
6006@smallexample
6007(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6008(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6009Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6010> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6011> while-stepping 11
6012 > collect $regs
6013 > end
6014> end
6015(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6016 [time passes @dots{}]
6017(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6018@end smallexample
6019
6020
6021@node Analyze Collected Data
6022@section Using the collected data
6023
6024After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6025for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6026collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6027snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6028consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6029examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6030specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6031snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6032registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6033rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6034debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6035(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6036behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6037when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6038the buffer will fail.
6039
6040@menu
6041* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6042* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6043* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6044@end menu
6045
6046@node tfind
6047@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6048
6049@kindex tfind
6050@cindex select trace snapshot
6051@cindex find trace snapshot
6052The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6053@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6054counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6055snapshot is selected.
6056
6057Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6058
6059@table @code
6060@item tfind start
6061Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6062@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6063
6064@item tfind none
6065Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6066
6067@item tfind end
6068Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6069
6070@item tfind
6071No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6072
6073@item tfind -
6074Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6075retracing earlier steps.
6076
6077@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6078Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6079proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6080argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6081for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6082
6083@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6084Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6085program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6086snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6087snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6088
6089@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6090Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6091addresses.
6092
6093@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6094Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6095@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6096
6097@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6098Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6099the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6100that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6101trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6102next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6103@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6104stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6105@end table
6106
6107The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6108designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6109instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6110snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6111trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6112simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6113snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6114@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6115The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6116for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6117no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6118(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6119no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6120tracepoint as the current one.
6121
6122In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6123these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6124scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6125you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6126registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6127
6128@smallexample
6129(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6130(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6131> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6132 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6133> tfind
6134> end
6135
6136Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6137Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6138Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6139Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6140Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6141Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6142Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6143Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6144Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6145Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6146Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6147@end smallexample
6148
6149Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6150the buffer:
6151
6152@smallexample
6153(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6154(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6155> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6156> tfind line
6157> end
6158
6159Frame 0, X = 1
6160Frame 7, X = 2
6161Frame 13, X = 255
6162@end smallexample
6163
6164@node tdump
6165@subsection @code{tdump}
6166@kindex tdump
6167@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6168@cindex tracepoint data, display
6169
6170This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6171the current trace snapshot.
6172
6173@smallexample
6174(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6175(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6176Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6177> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6178> end
6179
6180(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6181
6182(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6183#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6184at gdb_test.c:444
6185444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6186
6187(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6188Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6189d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6190d1 0x18 24
6191d2 0x80 128
6192d3 0x33 51
6193d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6194d5 0x22 34
6195d6 0xe0 224
6196d7 0x380035 3670069
6197a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6198a1 0x3000668 50333288
6199a2 0x100 256
6200a3 0x322000 3284992
6201a4 0x3000698 50333336
6202a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6203fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6204sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6205ps 0x0 0
6206pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6207fpcontrol 0x0 0
6208fpstatus 0x0 0
6209fpiaddr 0x0 0
6210p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6211p1 = (void *) 0x11
6212p2 = (void *) 0x22
6213p3 = (void *) 0x33
6214p4 = (void *) 0x44
6215p5 = (void *) 0x55
6216p6 = (void *) 0x66
6217gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6218
6219(@value{GDBP})
6220@end smallexample
6221
6222@node save-tracepoints
6223@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6224@kindex save-tracepoints
6225@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6226
6227This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6228their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6229suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6230tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6231Files}).
6232
6233@node Tracepoint Variables
6234@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6235@cindex tracepoint variables
6236@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6237
6238@table @code
6239@vindex $trace_frame
6240@item (int) $trace_frame
6241The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6242snapshot is selected.
6243
6244@vindex $tracepoint
6245@item (int) $tracepoint
6246The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6247
6248@vindex $trace_line
6249@item (int) $trace_line
6250The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6251
6252@vindex $trace_file
6253@item (char []) $trace_file
6254The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6255
6256@vindex $trace_func
6257@item (char []) $trace_func
6258The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6259@end table
6260
6261Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6262use @code{output} instead.
6263
6264Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6265stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6266data.
6267
6268@smallexample
6269(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6270
6271(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6272> output $trace_file
6273> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6274> tfind
6275> end
6276@end smallexample
6277
6d2ebf8b 6278@node Languages
c906108c
SS
6279@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6280@cindex languages
6281
c906108c
SS
6282Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6283rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6284dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6285Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 6286represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 6287@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
6288
6289@cindex working language
6290Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6291allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6292native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6293consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6294language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6295language}.
6296
6297@menu
6298* Setting:: Switching between source languages
6299* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 6300* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6301* Support:: Supported languages
6302@end menu
6303
6d2ebf8b 6304@node Setting
c906108c
SS
6305@section Switching between source languages
6306
6307There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6308set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6309@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6310defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6311used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6312are printed, etc.
6313
6314In addition to the working language, every source file that
6315@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6316file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6317source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6318language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 6319controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 6320show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
6321set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6322set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6323Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
6324
6325This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 6326as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
6327another language. In that case, make the
6328program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6329@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6330program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6331
6332@menu
6333* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6334* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6335* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6336@end menu
6337
6d2ebf8b 6338@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
6339@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6340
6341If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6342@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6343
6344@table @file
6345
6346@item .c
6347C source file
6348
6349@item .C
6350@itemx .cc
6351@itemx .cp
6352@itemx .cpp
6353@itemx .cxx
6354@itemx .c++
b37052ae 6355C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
6356
6357@item .f
6358@itemx .F
6359Fortran source file
6360
c906108c
SS
6361@item .ch
6362@itemx .c186
6363@itemx .c286
96a2c332 6364CHILL source file
c906108c 6365
c906108c
SS
6366@item .mod
6367Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
6368
6369@item .s
6370@itemx .S
6371Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6372@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6373@end table
6374
6375In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6376extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6377
6d2ebf8b 6378@node Manually
c906108c
SS
6379@subsection Setting the working language
6380
6381If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6382expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6383your program.
6384
6385@kindex set language
6386If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6387command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 6388a language, such as
c906108c 6389@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
6390For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6391
c906108c
SS
6392Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6393language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6394to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6395source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6396languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6397source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6398command such as:
6399
6400@example
6401print a = b + c
6402@end example
6403
6404@noindent
6405might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6406@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6407printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6408@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 6409
6d2ebf8b 6410@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
6411@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6412
6413To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6414@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6415then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6416frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6417working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6418frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6419or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6420does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6421not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6422
6423This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6424entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6425written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6426a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6427case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6428
6d2ebf8b 6429@node Show
c906108c 6430@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
6431
6432The following commands help you find out which language is the
6433working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6434
6435@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
6436@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6437@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
6438@table @code
6439@item show language
6440Display the current working language. This is the
6441language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6442build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6443
6444@item info frame
5d161b24 6445Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 6446working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 6447@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6448information listed here.
6449
6450@item info source
6451Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 6452@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6453information listed here.
6454@end table
6455
6456In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6457not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6458with a language explicitly:
6459
6460@kindex set extension-language
6461@kindex info extensions
6462@table @code
6463@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6464Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6465the source language @var{language}.
6466
6467@item info extensions
6468List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6469@end table
6470
6d2ebf8b 6471@node Checks
c906108c
SS
6472@section Type and range checking
6473
6474@quotation
6475@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6476checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6477section documents the intended facilities.
6478@end quotation
6479@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6480
6481Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6482errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6483checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6484sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6485these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6486by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6487errors when your program is running.
6488
6489@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6490Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6491can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6492the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6493@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6494your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6495for the default settings of supported languages.
6496
6497@menu
6498* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6499* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6500@end menu
6501
6502@cindex type checking
6503@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 6504@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
6505@subsection An overview of type checking
6506
6507Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6508arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6509otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
6510errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
6511
6512@smallexample
65131 + 2 @result{} 3
6514@exdent but
6515@error{} 1 + 2.3
6516@end smallexample
6517
6518The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6519type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6520
5d161b24
DB
6521For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6522@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6523to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6524or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
6525but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
6526these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6527also issues a warning.
6528
5d161b24
DB
6529Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6530related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6531For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6532a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
6533with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
6534the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6535
6536Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
6537instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6538operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6539represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6540operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6541details on specific languages.
6542
6543@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6544
d4f3574e 6545@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
6546@kindex set check type
6547@kindex show check type
6548@table @code
6549@item set check type auto
6550Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6551@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6552each language.
6553
6554@item set check type on
6555@itemx set check type off
6556Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6557current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
6558match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 6559evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
6560message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6561
6562@item set check type warn
6563Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
6564evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
6565be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
6566numbers and structures.
6567
6568@item show type
5d161b24 6569Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6570is setting it automatically.
6571@end table
6572
6573@cindex range checking
6574@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 6575@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
6576@subsection An overview of range checking
6577
6578In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
6579bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
6580checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
6581computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
6582not exceed the bounds of the array.
6583
6584For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
6585@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
6586always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
6587warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
6588
6589A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
6590array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
6591of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
6592error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
6593result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
6594the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
6595
6596@example
6597@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
6598@end example
6599
6600This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
6601specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
6602Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
6603
6604@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
6605
d4f3574e 6606@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
6607@kindex set check range
6608@kindex show check range
6609@table @code
6610@item set check range auto
6611Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
6612@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6613each language.
6614
6615@item set check range on
6616@itemx set check range off
6617Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6618current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
6619match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
6620then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
6621
6622@item set check range warn
6623Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
6624but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
6625expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
6626memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
6627systems).
6628
6629@item show range
6630Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
6631being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
6632@end table
c906108c 6633
6d2ebf8b 6634@node Support
c906108c 6635@section Supported languages
c906108c 6636
b37052ae 6637@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 6638@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
6639Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6640language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6641and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6642,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6643language.
6644
6645The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6646supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6647tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6648@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6649formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6650books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6651language reference or tutorial.
6652
c906108c 6653@menu
b37052ae 6654* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 6655* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 6656* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
6657@end menu
6658
6d2ebf8b 6659@node C
b37052ae 6660@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 6661
b37052ae
EZ
6662@cindex C and C@t{++}
6663@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 6664
b37052ae 6665Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
6666to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6667together.
6668
41afff9a
EZ
6669@cindex C@t{++}
6670@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
6671@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
6672The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
6673compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
6674effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
6675C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6676compiler (@code{aCC}).
6677
b37052ae 6678For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
6679format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6680command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6681@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6682CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 6683
c906108c 6684@menu
b37052ae
EZ
6685* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
6686* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
6687* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
6688* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
6689* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 6690* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 6691* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 6692@end menu
c906108c 6693
6d2ebf8b 6694@node C Operators
b37052ae 6695@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 6696
b37052ae 6697@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
6698
6699Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6700@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 6701often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 6702
b37052ae 6703For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
6704
6705@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 6706
c906108c 6707@item
c906108c 6708@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 6709specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
6710
6711@item
d4f3574e
SS
6712@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6713@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
6714
6715@item
53a5351d 6716@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
6717
6718@item
6719@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 6720
c906108c
SS
6721@end itemize
6722
6723@noindent
6724The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6725in order of increasing precedence:
6726
6727@table @code
6728@item ,
6729The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6730are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6731expression being the last expression evaluated.
6732
6733@item =
6734Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6735assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6736
6737@item @var{op}=
6738Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6739and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 6740@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
6741@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6742@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6743
6744@item ?:
6745The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6746of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6747integral type.
6748
6749@item ||
6750Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6751
6752@item &&
6753Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6754
6755@item |
6756Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6757
6758@item ^
6759Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6760
6761@item &
6762Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6763
6764@item ==@r{, }!=
6765Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6766expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6767
6768@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6769Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6770Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6771and non-zero for true.
6772
6773@item <<@r{, }>>
6774left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6775
6776@item @@
6777The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6778
6779@item +@r{, }-
6780Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6781pointer types.
6782
6783@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6784Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6785defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6786integral types.
6787
6788@item ++@r{, }--
6789Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6790operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6791when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6792operation takes place.
6793
6794@item *
6795Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6796@code{++}.
6797
6798@item &
6799Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6800
b37052ae
EZ
6801For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6802allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 6803(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 6804where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 6805stored.
c906108c
SS
6806
6807@item -
6808Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6809precedence as @code{++}.
6810
6811@item !
6812Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6813@code{++}.
6814
6815@item ~
6816Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6817@code{++}.
6818
6819
6820@item .@r{, }->
6821Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6822@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6823pointer based on the stored type information.
6824Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6825
c906108c
SS
6826@item .*@r{, }->*
6827Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6828
6829@item []
6830Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6831@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6832
6833@item ()
6834Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6835
c906108c 6836@item ::
b37052ae 6837C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 6838and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6839
6840@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6841Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6842(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6843above.
c906108c
SS
6844@end table
6845
c906108c
SS
6846If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6847attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6848predefined meaning.
c906108c 6849
c906108c 6850@menu
5d161b24 6851* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6852@end menu
6853
6d2ebf8b 6854@node C Constants
b37052ae 6855@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6856
b37052ae 6857@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6858
b37052ae 6859@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 6860following ways:
c906108c
SS
6861
6862@itemize @bullet
6863@item
6864Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6865specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6866a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6867@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6868@code{long} value.
6869
6870@item
6871Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6872point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6873exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6874@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6875sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6876A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6877@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6878the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6879a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6880constant.
c906108c
SS
6881
6882@item
6883Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6884integral equivalents.
6885
6886@item
6887Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6888(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6889(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6890be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6891the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6892of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6893@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6894@samp{\n} for newline.
6895
6896@item
96a2c332
SS
6897String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6898double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6899above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6900a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6901characters.
c906108c
SS
6902
6903@item
6904Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6905to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6906
6907@item
6908Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6909and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6910integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6911and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6912@end itemize
6913
c906108c 6914@menu
5d161b24
DB
6915* C plus plus expressions::
6916* C Defaults::
6917* C Checks::
c906108c 6918
5d161b24 6919* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6920@end menu
6921
6d2ebf8b 6922@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
6923@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
6924
6925@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
6926@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
6927
6928@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
6929@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
6930@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
6931@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
6932@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
6933@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
6934@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
6935@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
6936@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6937@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6938@c periodically whether this has happened...
6939@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
6940@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
6941proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
6942additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6943special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6944@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6945symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6946you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6947extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 6948@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6949support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6950@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6951
6952@enumerate
6953
6954@cindex member functions
6955@item
6956Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6957
6958@example
6959count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6960@end example
6961
41afff9a 6962@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 6963@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6964@item
6965While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6966expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6967that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 6968pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 6969
c906108c 6970@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6971@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 6972@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6973@item
6974You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6975call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6976perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6977calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6978in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6979default arguments.
6980
6981It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6982promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6983class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6984functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6985number of function arguments.
6986
6987Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6988@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 6989,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 6990
d4f3574e 6991You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6992explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6993@smallexample
6994p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6995@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6996
c906108c 6997The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6998see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6999
c906108c
SS
7000@cindex reference declarations
7001@item
b37052ae
EZ
7002@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7003them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
7004dereferenced.
7005
7006In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7007reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7008avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7009The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7010you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7011
7012@item
b37052ae 7013@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7014expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7015one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7016necessary, for example in an expression like
7017@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7018resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7019debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7020@end enumerate
7021
b37052ae 7022In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7023calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7024objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7025invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7026
6d2ebf8b 7027@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7028@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7029
b37052ae 7030@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7031
c906108c
SS
7032If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7033both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7034C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7035selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7036
7037If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7038recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7039@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7040these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7041@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7042for further details.
7043
c906108c
SS
7044@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7045@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7046@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7047
6d2ebf8b 7048@node C Checks
b37052ae 7049@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7050
b37052ae 7051@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7052
b37052ae 7053By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7054is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7055considers two variables type equivalent if:
7056
7057@itemize @bullet
7058@item
7059The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7060enumerated tag.
7061
7062@item
7063The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7064declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7065
7066@ignore
7067@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7068@c FIXME--beers?
7069@item
7070The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7071declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7072compilers.)
7073@end ignore
7074@end itemize
7075
7076Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7077indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7078that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7079
6d2ebf8b 7080@node Debugging C
c906108c 7081@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7082
7083The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7084the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7085inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7086appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7087
7088The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7089with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7090,Expressions}.
7091
c906108c 7092@menu
5d161b24 7093* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7094@end menu
7095
6d2ebf8b 7096@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7097@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7098
b37052ae 7099@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7100
b37052ae
EZ
7101Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7102designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7103
7104@table @code
7105@cindex break in overloaded functions
7106@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7107When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7108@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7109you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7110
b37052ae 7111@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7112@item rbreak @var{regex}
7113Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7114breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7115classes.
7116@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7117
b37052ae 7118@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7119@item catch throw
7120@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7121Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7122Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7123
7124@cindex inheritance
7125@item ptype @var{typename}
7126Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7127@var{typename}.
7128@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7129
b37052ae 7130@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7131@item set print demangle
7132@itemx show print demangle
7133@itemx set print asm-demangle
7134@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7135Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7136displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7137@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7138
7139@item set print object
7140@itemx show print object
7141Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7142@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7143
7144@item set print vtbl
7145@itemx show print vtbl
7146Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7147@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7148(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7149ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7150
7151@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7152@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7153@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7154Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7155is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7156and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7157using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7158expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7159message.
7160
7161@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7162Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7163overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7164chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7165symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7166overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7167searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7168argument types.
c906108c
SS
7169
7170@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7171You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7172the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7173@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7174also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7175available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7176@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7177@end table
c906108c 7178
6d2ebf8b 7179@node Modula-2
c906108c 7180@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7181
d4f3574e 7182@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7183
7184The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7185output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7186developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7187attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7188to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7189table.
7190
7191@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7192@menu
7193* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7194* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7195* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7196* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7197* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7198* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7199* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7200* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7201@end menu
7202
6d2ebf8b 7203@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7204@subsubsection Operators
7205@cindex Modula-2 operators
7206
7207Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7208@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7209often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7210following definitions hold:
7211
7212@itemize @bullet
7213
7214@item
7215@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7216their subranges.
7217
7218@item
7219@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7220
7221@item
7222@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7223
7224@item
7225@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7226@var{type}}.
7227
7228@item
7229@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7230
7231@item
7232@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7233
7234@item
7235@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7236@end itemize
7237
7238@noindent
7239The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7240increasing precedence:
7241
7242@table @code
7243@item ,
7244Function argument or array index separator.
7245
7246@item :=
7247Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7248@var{value}.
7249
7250@item <@r{, }>
7251Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7252types.
7253
7254@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 7255Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
7256on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7257set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7258
7259@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7260Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7261Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7262available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7263comment character.
7264
7265@item IN
7266Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7267Same precedence as @code{<}.
7268
7269@item OR
7270Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7271
7272@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 7273Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
7274
7275@item @@
7276The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7277
7278@item +@r{, }-
7279Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7280and difference on set types.
7281
7282@item *
7283Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7284on set types.
7285
7286@item /
7287Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7288types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7289
7290@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7291Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7292precedence as @code{*}.
7293
7294@item -
7295Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7296
7297@item ^
7298Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7299
7300@item NOT
7301Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7302@code{^}.
7303
7304@item .
7305@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7306precedence as @code{^}.
7307
7308@item []
7309Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7310
7311@item ()
7312Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7313as @code{^}.
7314
7315@item ::@r{, }.
7316@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7317@end table
7318
7319@quotation
7320@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7321treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7322@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7323@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7324@end quotation
7325
cb51c4e0 7326
6d2ebf8b 7327@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 7328@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 7329@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
7330
7331Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7332In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7333
7334@table @var
7335
7336@item a
7337represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7338
7339@item c
7340represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7341
7342@item i
7343represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7344
7345@item m
7346represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7347same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7348be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7349
7350@item n
7351represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7352
7353@item r
7354represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7355
7356@item t
7357represents a type.
7358
7359@item v
7360represents a variable.
7361
7362@item x
7363represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7364explanation of the function for details.
7365@end table
7366
7367All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7368
7369@table @code
7370@item ABS(@var{n})
7371Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7372
7373@item CAP(@var{c})
7374If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 7375equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
7376
7377@item CHR(@var{i})
7378Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7379
7380@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7381Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7382
7383@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7384Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7385new value.
7386
7387@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7388Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7389set.
7390
7391@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7392Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7393
7394@item HIGH(@var{a})
7395Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7396
7397@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7398Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7399
7400@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7401Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7402new value.
7403
7404@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7405Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7406there. Returns the new set.
7407
7408@item MAX(@var{t})
7409Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7410
7411@item MIN(@var{t})
7412Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7413
7414@item ODD(@var{i})
7415Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7416
7417@item ORD(@var{x})
7418Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
7419value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7420@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
7421integral, character and enumerated types.
7422
7423@item SIZE(@var{x})
7424Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7425
7426@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7427Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7428
7429@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7430Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7431@end table
7432
7433@quotation
7434@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7435@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7436an error.
7437@end quotation
7438
7439@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 7440@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
7441@subsubsection Constants
7442
7443@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7444ways:
7445
7446@itemize @bullet
7447
7448@item
7449Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7450expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7451rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7452trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7453
7454@item
7455Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7456decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7457then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7458@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7459digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7460digits.
7461
7462@item
7463Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7464like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 7465also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
7466followed by a @samp{C}.
7467
7468@item
7469String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7470pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7471Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 7472Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
7473sequences.
7474
7475@item
7476Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7477
7478@item
7479Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7480@code{FALSE}.
7481
7482@item
7483Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7484
7485@item
7486Set constants are not yet supported.
7487@end itemize
7488
6d2ebf8b 7489@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
7490@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7491@cindex Modula-2 defaults
7492
7493If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7494both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7495Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7496selected the working language.
7497
7498If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7499code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 7500working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
7501the language automatically}, for further details.
7502
6d2ebf8b 7503@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
7504@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7505@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7506
7507A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7508This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7509
7510@itemize @bullet
7511@item
7512Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7513integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7514debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7515pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7516through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7517returned a pointer.)
7518
7519@item
7520C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7521non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7522escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
7523printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7524
7525@item
7526The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7527argument.
7528
7529@item
7530All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7531@end itemize
7532
6d2ebf8b 7533@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
7534@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7535@cindex Modula-2 checks
7536
7537@quotation
7538@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7539range checking.
7540@end quotation
7541@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7542
7543@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7544
7545@itemize @bullet
7546@item
7547They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7548@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7549
7550@item
7551They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
7552@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7553@end itemize
7554
7555As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7556whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7557
7558Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7559index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7560
6d2ebf8b 7561@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
7562@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7563@cindex scope
41afff9a 7564@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
7565@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
7566@ifinfo
41afff9a 7567@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7568@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
7569@end ifinfo
7570@iftex
41afff9a 7571@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7572@end iftex
7573
7574There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
7575(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
7576similar syntax:
7577
7578@example
7579
7580@var{module} . @var{id}
7581@var{scope} :: @var{id}
7582@end example
7583
7584@noindent
7585where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
7586@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
7587identifier within your program, except another module.
7588
7589Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
7590specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
7591found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
7592enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
7593
7594Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
7595the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
7596definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
7597an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
7598module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
7599@var{module}.
7600
6d2ebf8b 7601@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
7602@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7603
7604Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
7605Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 7606specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 7607@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 7608apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
7609analogue in Modula-2.
7610
7611The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 7612with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 7613intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 7614created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 7615address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 7616@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
7617
7618@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
7619In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
7620interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 7621
6d2ebf8b 7622@node Chill
cce74817
JM
7623@subsection Chill
7624
7625The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 7626from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
7627supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
7628likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7629table.
7630
d4f3574e
SS
7631@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
7632@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
7633This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
7634of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
7635
7636@menu
104c1213
JM
7637* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
7638* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 7639* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 7640* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 7641* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
7642@end menu
7643
6d2ebf8b 7644@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
7645@subsubsection How modes are displayed
7646
7647The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 7648with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
7649slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7650provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
7651
7652@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7653@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
7654@table @code
7655@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7656@itemize @bullet
7657@item
7658@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7659UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7660@item
5d161b24 7661@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 7662@item
5d161b24 7663@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
7664@item
7665@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7666@smallexample
7667(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7668type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7669@end smallexample
7670If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7671@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7672@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7673@smallexample
7674@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7675@end smallexample
7676where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7677expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
7678@end itemize
7679
7680@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7681A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 7682the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
7683@smallexample
7684(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7685type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7686@end smallexample
7687
7688@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7689@itemize @bullet
7690@item
d4f3574e 7691@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
7692followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7693@item
7694@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7695@end itemize
7696
7697@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7698The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7699<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
7700list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7701the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
7702all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7703
7704@ignore
7705@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7706The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 7707type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
7708@end ignore
7709
5d161b24 7710@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7711@itemize @bullet
7712@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7713@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7714@smallexample
7715@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7716@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7717where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7718@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7719@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7720@smallexample
7721@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7722@end smallexample
7723where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
7724@end itemize
7725
5d161b24 7726@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7727@itemize @bullet
7728@item
7729@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7730@item
7731@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7732@end itemize
7733
7734@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7735Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7736
7737@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7738@itemize @bullet
7739@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7740@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7741@smallexample
7742@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7743@end smallexample
7744followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7745mode
cce74817 7746@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7747@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7748@smallexample
7749@code{BOOLS(<string
7750length>)}
7751@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7752@end itemize
7753
7754@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7755The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7756followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7757@smallexample
7758(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
7759type = ARRAY (1:42)
7760 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
7761 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7762@end smallexample
7763
5d161b24 7764@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 7765The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
7766list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7767of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7768OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
7769of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7770checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7771always displays all variant fields.
7772@smallexample
7773(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7774type = STRUCT (
7775 as x,
7776 bs x,
7777 CASE bs OF
7778 (karli):
7779 cs a
7780 (ott):
7781 ds x
7782 ESAC
7783)
7784@end smallexample
7785@end table
7786
6d2ebf8b 7787@node Locations
cce74817
JM
7788@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7789
7790A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7791
7792A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7793the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7794Chill programs. How values are specified
7795is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7796
7797The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7798display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7799
cce74817
JM
7800@smallexample
7801set result := EXPR
7802@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7803
7804@noindent
7805This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7806is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7807
7808Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7809value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7810mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7811represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7812value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7813operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7814
6d2ebf8b
SS
7815Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7816@smallexample
7817@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7818(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7819location>}
7820@end smallexample
7821@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7822specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7823the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7824
7825@ignore
7826Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7827fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7828the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7829implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7830na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7831<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7832@code{__proc_copy}.
7833
7834Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7835the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7836like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7837mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7838
7839Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7840...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7841definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7842of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7843structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7844braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7845on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7846memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7847all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7848@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7849stuff ???)
7850@smallexample
7851(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7852[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7853@end smallexample
7854@end ignore
7855
7856Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7857(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7858certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7859and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7860
7861A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7862location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7863name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7864have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7865checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7866therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7867
cce74817
JM
7868@smallexample
7869(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7870@end smallexample
7871
6d2ebf8b 7872@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7873@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7874
7875Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7876more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7877data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7878such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7879constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7880when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7881(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7882the values behind these locations.
7883
d4f3574e 7884This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7885operations are legal to be used with such values.
7886
7887@table @code
7888@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7889Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7890For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7891chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7892@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7893@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7894
5d161b24 7895@ignore
cce74817
JM
7896@itemize @bullet
7897@item
7898@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7899programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7900@item
7901@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7902@item
7903@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7904@code{'M'})
7905@item
7906@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e 7907mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
b37052ae 7908comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
cce74817 7909@item
d4f3574e 7910@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7911emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7912procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7913
7914@item
7915@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7916enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7917to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7918@item
7919@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7920programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7921@item
7922@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7923(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7924@end itemize
7925@end ignore
7926
7927@item Tuple Values
7928A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7929name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7930unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7931@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7932
cce74817
JM
7933@itemize @bullet
7934@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7935@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7936@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7937Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7938same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7939@end itemize
7940
7941@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7942A string element value is specified by
7943@smallexample
7944@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7945@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7946where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7947value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7948the string.
7949
7950@item String Slice Value
7951A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7952spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7953expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7954@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7955The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7956string.
7957
7958@item Array Element Values
7959An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7960delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7961
7962@item Array Slice Values
7963An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7964@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7965@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7966arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7967which is part of the specified array.
7968
7969@item Structure Field Values
7970A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7971name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7972in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7973corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7974
7975@item Procedure Call Value
7976The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7977procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7978expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7979effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7980
d4f3574e 7981Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7982
6d2ebf8b
SS
7983Values of time mode locations appear as
7984@smallexample
7985@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7986@end smallexample
7987
cce74817
JM
7988
7989@ignore
7990This is not implemented yet:
7991@item Built-in Value
7992@noindent
7993The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7994
cce74817
JM
7995@table @code
7996@item @code{ADDR()}
7997@item @code{NUM()}
7998@item @code{PRED()}
7999@item @code{SUCC()}
8000@item @code{ABS()}
8001@item @code{CARD()}
8002@item @code{MAX()}
8003@item @code{MIN()}
8004@item @code{SIZE()}
8005@item @code{UPPER()}
8006@item @code{LOWER()}
8007@item @code{LENGTH()}
8008@item @code{SIN()}
8009@item @code{COS()}
8010@item @code{TAN()}
8011@item @code{ARCSIN()}
8012@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8013@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8014@item @code{EXP()}
8015@item @code{LN()}
8016@item @code{LOG()}
8017@item @code{SQRT()}
8018@end table
8019
8020For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8021chapter 1.6.
8022@end ignore
8023
8024@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8025The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8026current active process.
8027
8028@item Expression Values
8029The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 8030the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 8031incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 8032corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 8033causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 8034which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 8035operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 8036
cce74817
JM
8037@table @code
8038@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8039@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8040@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8041Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 8042
cce74817
JM
8043@item @code{=, /=}
8044Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 8045
cce74817 8046@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8047@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8048Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8049
cce74817 8050@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 8051@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 8052Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8053
cce74817
JM
8054@item @code{-}
8055Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 8056
cce74817
JM
8057@item @code{//}
8058String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 8059
cce74817
JM
8060@item @code{()}
8061String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 8062
cce74817
JM
8063@item @code{->}
8064Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8065address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8066location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 8067
cce74817 8068@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8069@itemx @code{AND}
8070@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8071Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 8072
cce74817 8073@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8074@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8075Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 8076
cce74817
JM
8077@item @code{IN}
8078Membership operator.
8079@end table
8080@end table
8081
6d2ebf8b 8082@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
8083@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8084
8085@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 8086of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 8087complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 8088equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
8089structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8090
8091Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8092index bounds and all built in procedures.
8093
8094Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 8095check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
8096operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8097functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8098language specification.
8099
cce74817
JM
8100All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8101off}.
8102
5d161b24 8103@ignore
53a5351d 8104@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
8105see last paragraph ?
8106@end ignore
8107
6d2ebf8b 8108@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
8109@subsubsection Chill defaults
8110
8111If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8112both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8113Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
8114selected the working language.
8115
8116If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8117code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 8118working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
8119the language automatically}, for further details.
8120
6d2ebf8b 8121@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8122@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8123
d4f3574e 8124The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8125symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8126program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8127does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8128program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8129(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8130file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8131
8132@cindex symbol names
8133@cindex names of symbols
8134@cindex quoting names
8135Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8136characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8137most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8138source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8139are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8140ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8141@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8142@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8143
8144@example
8145p 'foo.c'::x
8146@end example
8147
8148@noindent
8149looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8150
8151@table @code
8152@kindex info address
b37052ae 8153@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8154@item info address @var{symbol}
8155Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8156variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8157local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8158is always stored.
8159
8160Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8161at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8162the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8163
3d67e040 8164@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8165@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8166@item info symbol @var{addr}
8167Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8168If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8169nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8170
8171@example
8172(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8173_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8174@end example
8175
8176@noindent
8177This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8178it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8179
c906108c 8180@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8181@item whatis @var{expr}
8182Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8183actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8184assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8185@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8186
8187@item whatis
8188Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8189
8190@kindex ptype
8191@item ptype @var{typename}
8192Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8193the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8194@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8195@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8196
d4f3574e 8197@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8198@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8199Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8200differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8201of just the name of the type.
8202
8203For example, for this variable declaration:
8204
8205@example
8206struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8207@end example
8208
8209@noindent
8210the two commands give this output:
8211
8212@example
8213@group
8214(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8215type = struct complex
8216(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8217type = struct complex @{
8218 double real;
8219 double imag;
8220@}
8221@end group
8222@end example
8223
8224@noindent
8225As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8226the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8227
8228@kindex info types
8229@item info types @var{regexp}
8230@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8231Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8232(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8233complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8234@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8235names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8236information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8237
8238This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8239@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8240lists all source files where a type is defined.
8241
b37052ae
EZ
8242@kindex info scope
8243@cindex local variables
8244@item info scope @var{addr}
8245List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8246accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8247preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8248scope defined by that location. For example:
8249
8250@smallexample
8251(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8252Scope for command_line_handler:
8253Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8254Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8255Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8256Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8257Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8258Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8259Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8260@end smallexample
8261
f5c37c66
EZ
8262@noindent
8263This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8264during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8265collect}.
8266
c906108c
SS
8267@kindex info source
8268@item info source
8269Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8270the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8271it was written in.
8272
8273@kindex info sources
8274@item info sources
8275Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8276debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8277have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8278
8279@kindex info functions
8280@item info functions
8281Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8282
8283@item info functions @var{regexp}
8284Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8285whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8286Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8287include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8288start with @code{step}.
8289
8290@kindex info variables
8291@item info variables
8292Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8293outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8294
8295@item info variables @var{regexp}
8296Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8297variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8298@var{regexp}.
8299
8300@ignore
8301This was never implemented.
8302@kindex info methods
8303@item info methods
8304@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8305The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8306methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8307specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8308C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8309from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8310@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8311which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8312@end ignore
8313
c906108c
SS
8314@cindex reloading symbols
8315Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8316be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8317in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8318running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8319@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8320
8321@table @code
8322@kindex set symbol-reloading
8323@item set symbol-reloading on
8324Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8325object file with a particular name is seen again.
8326
8327@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8328Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8329same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8330running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8331should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8332may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8333several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8334name.
c906108c
SS
8335
8336@kindex show symbol-reloading
8337@item show symbol-reloading
8338Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8339@end table
c906108c 8340
c906108c
SS
8341@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8342@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8343Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8344declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8345@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8346source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8347another source file. The default is on.
8348
8349A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8350the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8351
8352@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8353Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8354is printed as follows:
8355@smallexample
8356@{<no data fields>@}
8357@end smallexample
8358
8359@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8360@item show opaque-type-resolution
8361Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8362
8363@kindex maint print symbols
8364@cindex symbol dump
8365@kindex maint print psymbols
8366@cindex partial symbol dump
8367@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8368@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8369@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8370Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8371These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8372symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8373symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8374collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8375only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8376command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8377use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8378symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8379files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8380@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8381required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8382@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8383@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8384@end table
8385
6d2ebf8b 8386@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8387@chapter Altering Execution
8388
8389Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8390find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8391correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8392experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8393program.
8394
8395For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
8396locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8397address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
8398
8399@menu
8400* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8401* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 8402* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
8403* Returning:: Returning from a function
8404* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8405* Patching:: Patching your program
8406@end menu
8407
6d2ebf8b 8408@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
8409@section Assignment to variables
8410
8411@cindex assignment
8412@cindex setting variables
8413To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8414@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8415
8416@example
8417print x=4
8418@end example
8419
8420@noindent
8421stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 8422value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
8423@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8424information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
8425
8426@kindex set variable
8427@cindex variables, setting
8428If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8429@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8430really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8431not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8432,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8433
c906108c
SS
8434If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8435appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8436variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8437to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8438program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8439a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8440command @code{set width}:
8441
8442@example
8443(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8444type = double
8445(@value{GDBP}) p width
8446$4 = 13
8447(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8448Invalid syntax in expression.
8449@end example
8450
8451@noindent
8452The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8453order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8454
8455@example
8456(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8457@end example
53a5351d 8458
c906108c
SS
8459Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8460with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8461@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8462your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8463to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8464the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8465
8466@example
8467@group
8468(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8469type = double
8470(@value{GDBP}) p g
8471$1 = 1
8472(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 8473(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
8474$2 = 1
8475(@value{GDBP}) r
8476The program being debugged has been started already.
8477Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8478Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
8479"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8480 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
8481(@value{GDBP}) show g
8482The current BFD target is "=4".
8483@end group
8484@end example
8485
8486@noindent
8487The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8488@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8489@code{g}, use
8490
8491@example
8492(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8493@end example
c906108c
SS
8494
8495@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8496freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8497and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8498same length or shorter.
8499@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8500@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8501
8502To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8503construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8504(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8505to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8506and representation in memory), and
8507
8508@example
8509set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8510@end example
8511
8512@noindent
8513stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8514
6d2ebf8b 8515@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
8516@section Continuing at a different address
8517
8518Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8519it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
8520an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8521
8522@table @code
8523@kindex jump
8524@item jump @var{linespec}
8525Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
8526immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
8527source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8528@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8529in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8530breakpoints}.
8531
8532The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8533the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8534register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
8535a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8536be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8537of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8538confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8539executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8540well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8541
8542@item jump *@var{address}
8543Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8544@end table
8545
c906108c 8546@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
8547On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8548command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
8549difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8550changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
8551example,
c906108c
SS
8552
8553@example
8554set $pc = 0x485
8555@end example
8556
8557@noindent
8558makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8559address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8560@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
8561
8562The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
8563up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
8564that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
8565detail.
8566
c906108c 8567@c @group
6d2ebf8b 8568@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
8569@section Giving your program a signal
8570
8571@table @code
8572@kindex signal
8573@item signal @var{signal}
8574Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
8575signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
8576signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
8577SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
8578
8579Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
8580giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
8581a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
8582@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
8583signal.
8584
8585@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
8586after executing the command.
8587@end table
8588@c @end group
8589
8590Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
8591@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
8592causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
8593the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
8594passes the signal directly to your program.
8595
c906108c 8596
6d2ebf8b 8597@node Returning
c906108c
SS
8598@section Returning from a function
8599
8600@table @code
8601@cindex returning from a function
8602@kindex return
8603@item return
8604@itemx return @var{expression}
8605You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
8606command. If you give an
8607@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
8608value.
8609@end table
8610
8611When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
8612(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
8613discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
8614be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
8615
8616This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
8617frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
8618innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
8619specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
8620of functions.
8621
8622The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
8623program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
8624returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
8625and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
8626selected stack frame returns naturally.
8627
6d2ebf8b 8628@node Calling
c906108c
SS
8629@section Calling program functions
8630
8631@cindex calling functions
8632@kindex call
8633@table @code
8634@item call @var{expr}
8635Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
8636returned values.
8637@end table
8638
8639You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
8640execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
8641with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
8642is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 8643
c906108c
SS
8644For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
8645specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
8646calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
8647method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
8648that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 8649
6d2ebf8b 8650@node Patching
c906108c 8651@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 8652
c906108c
SS
8653@cindex patching binaries
8654@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 8655@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 8656
7a292a7a
SS
8657By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
8658executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
8659alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
8660patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
8661
8662If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
8663explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
8664want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
8665repairs.
8666
8667@table @code
8668@kindex set write
8669@item set write on
8670@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
8671If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
8672core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
8673off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
8674
8675If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
8676@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
8677write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
8678
8679@item show write
8680@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
8681Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8682as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
8683@end table
8684
6d2ebf8b 8685@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
8686@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8687
7a292a7a
SS
8688@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8689both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8690program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8691@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
8692
8693@menu
8694* Files:: Commands to specify files
8695* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8696@end menu
8697
6d2ebf8b 8698@node Files
c906108c 8699@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 8700
7a292a7a 8701@cindex symbol table
c906108c 8702@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
8703
8704You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8705way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8706@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8707Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
8708
8709Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8710@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8711a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8712to specify new files are useful.
8713
8714@table @code
8715@cindex executable file
8716@kindex file
8717@item file @var{filename}
8718Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8719symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8720executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
8721directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8722@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8723directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8724to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8725and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8726
6d2ebf8b 8727On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
8728@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8729@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8730@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8731descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8732(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 8733@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 8734for more information.
c906108c
SS
8735
8736@item file
8737@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8738has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8739
8740@kindex exec-file
8741@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8742Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8743in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8744if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8745discard information on the executable file.
8746
8747@kindex symbol-file
8748@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8749Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8750searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8751table and program to run from the same file.
8752
8753@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8754program's symbol table.
8755
5d161b24 8756The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
8757of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8758auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8759the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8760the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8761
8762@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8763executing it once.
8764
8765When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8766understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8767generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8768other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
8769Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8770using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8771optimized code.
c906108c
SS
8772
8773For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8774using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8775symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8776quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8777details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8778
8779The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8780start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8781occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8782file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8783pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8784warnings and messages}.)
8785
c906108c
SS
8786We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8787symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8788symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8789still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8790in stabs format.
8791
8792@kindex readnow
8793@cindex reading symbols immediately
8794@cindex symbols, reading immediately
8795@kindex mapped
8796@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8797@cindex saving symbol table
8798@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8799@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8800You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8801tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8802load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 8803entire symbol table available.
c906108c 8804
c906108c
SS
8805If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8806@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8807cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8808file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8809from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8810than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8811program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8812starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8813
8814You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8815file has all the symbol information for your program.
8816
8817The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8818@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8819than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8820it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8821needed.
8822
8823The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8824@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8825symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
8826
8827@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8828@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8829@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8830@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8831@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8832@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8833@c files.
8834
8835@kindex core
8836@kindex core-file
8837@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8838Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8839of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8840address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8841executable file itself for other parts.
8842
8843@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8844to be used.
8845
8846Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8847under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8848wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8849the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8850(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8851
c906108c
SS
8852@kindex add-symbol-file
8853@cindex dynamic linking
8854@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8855@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
d167840f 8856@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
96a2c332
SS
8857The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8858information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8859when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8860into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8861address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8862this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8863of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8864section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8865@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8866
8867The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8868originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8869@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8870thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8871instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c
SS
8872
8873@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8874
8875You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8876the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8877table information for @var{filename}.
8878
8879@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8880@item add-shared-symbol-file
8881The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8882operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8883shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8884@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8885
c906108c
SS
8886@kindex section
8887@item section
5d161b24
DB
8888The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8889the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8890section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8891specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8892separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8893the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8894
8895@kindex info files
8896@kindex info target
8897@item info files
8898@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8899@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8900current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8901including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8902use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8903command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8904current ones.
8905
c906108c
SS
8906@end table
8907
8908All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8909as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8910name and remembers it that way.
8911
c906108c 8912@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8913@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8914libraries.
53a5351d 8915
c906108c
SS
8916@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8917when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8918(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8919references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8920debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8921
8922On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8923automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8924
c906108c
SS
8925@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8926@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8927@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8928
8929@table @code
8930@kindex info sharedlibrary
8931@kindex info share
8932@item info share
8933@itemx info sharedlibrary
8934Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8935
8936@kindex sharedlibrary
8937@kindex share
8938@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8939@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
8940Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8941Unix regular expression.
8942As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8943required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8944@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8945loaded.
8946@end table
8947
53a5351d
JM
8948On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8949and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8950a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8951
8952Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8953loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8954@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8955automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8956
8957To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8958
8959@table @code
8960@kindex set auto-solib-add
8961@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8962Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8963nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8964automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8965linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8966the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8967Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8968@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8969
8970@kindex show auto-solib-add
8971@item show auto-solib-add
8972Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8973@end table
c906108c 8974
6d2ebf8b 8975@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8976@section Errors reading symbol files
8977
8978While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8979such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8980output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8981they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8982debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8983about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8984only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8985times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8986to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8987complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8988messages}).
8989
8990The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8991
8992@table @code
8993@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8994
8995The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8996(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8997error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8998in its outer scope blocks.
8999
9000@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9001the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9002may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9003function.
9004
9005@item block at @var{address} out of order
9006
9007The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9008order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9009do so.
9010
9011@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9012locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9013can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9014@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9015messages}.)
9016
9017@item bad block start address patched
9018
9019The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9020smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9021to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9022
9023@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9024starting on the previous source line.
9025
9026@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9027
9028@cindex foo
9029Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9030larger than the size of the string table.
9031
9032@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9033name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9034with this name.
9035
9036@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9037
7a292a7a
SS
9038The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9039not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9040uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9041
7a292a7a
SS
9042@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9043This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9044are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9045debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9046on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9047and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9048
9049@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9050
7a292a7a 9051@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9052
7a292a7a 9053@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9054The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9055information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9056it.
c906108c
SS
9057
9058@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9059
9060@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9061
c906108c
SS
9062@end table
9063
6d2ebf8b 9064@node Targets
c906108c 9065@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9066
c906108c
SS
9067@cindex debugging target
9068@kindex target
9069
9070A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9071
9072Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9073in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9074you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9075flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9076host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9077realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9078command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9079(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9080
9081@menu
9082* Active Targets:: Active targets
9083* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9084* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9085* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9086* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9087
9088@end menu
9089
6d2ebf8b 9090@node Active Targets
c906108c 9091@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9092
c906108c
SS
9093@cindex stacking targets
9094@cindex active targets
9095@cindex multiple targets
9096
c906108c 9097There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9098executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9099active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9100start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9101a core file.
c906108c
SS
9102
9103For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9104@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9105well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9106@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9107first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9108requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9109are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9110read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9111executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9112
9113When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9114target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9115commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9116an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9117process target is active.
c906108c 9118
7a292a7a
SS
9119Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9120core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9121files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9122the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9123process}).
c906108c 9124
6d2ebf8b 9125@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9126@section Commands for managing targets
9127
9128@table @code
9129@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9130Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9131process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9132facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9133protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9134
9135Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9136typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9137with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9138
9139The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9140after executing the command.
9141
9142@kindex help target
9143@item help target
9144Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9145currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9146(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9147
9148@item help target @var{name}
9149Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9150select it.
9151
9152@kindex set gnutarget
9153@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9154@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9155knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9156a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9157with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9158with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9159
d4f3574e 9160@quotation
c906108c
SS
9161@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9162you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9163@end quotation
c906108c 9164
d4f3574e
SS
9165@noindent
9166@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9167
5d161b24 9168@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9169@item show gnutarget
9170Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9171@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9172@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9173and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9174@end table
9175
c906108c
SS
9176Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9177configuration):
c906108c
SS
9178
9179@table @code
9180@kindex target exec
9181@item target exec @var{program}
9182An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9183@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9184
c906108c
SS
9185@kindex target core
9186@item target core @var{filename}
9187A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9188@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9189
9190@kindex target remote
9191@item target remote @var{dev}
9192Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9193specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9194@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9195supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9196some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9197it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9198
c906108c
SS
9199@kindex target sim
9200@item target sim
2df3850c 9201Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
9202In general,
9203@example
9204 target sim
9205 load
9206 run
9207@end example
d4f3574e 9208@noindent
104c1213 9209works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9210drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9211provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9212see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9213Processors}.
9214
c906108c
SS
9215@end table
9216
104c1213 9217Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9218
9219@table @code
9220
c906108c
SS
9221@kindex target nrom
9222@item target nrom @var{dev}
9223NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9224
c906108c
SS
9225@end table
9226
5d161b24 9227Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9228your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9229
9230Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9231once you've successfully established a connection.
9232
9233@table @code
9234
9235@kindex load @var{filename}
9236@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9237Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9238@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9239is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9240on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9241@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9242the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9243
9244If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9245execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9246target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9247
9248The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9249For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9250link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9251specifies a fixed address.
9252@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9253
c906108c
SS
9254@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9255@end table
9256
6d2ebf8b 9257@node Byte Order
c906108c 9258@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9259
c906108c
SS
9260@cindex choosing target byte order
9261@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9262
9263Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9264offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9265orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9266designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9267which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9268@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9269
9270@table @code
9271@kindex set endian big
9272@item set endian big
9273Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9274
9275@kindex set endian little
9276@item set endian little
9277Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9278
9279@kindex set endian auto
9280@item set endian auto
9281Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9282executable.
9283
9284@item show endian
9285Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9286
9287@end table
9288
9289Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9290data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9291target system.
9292
6d2ebf8b 9293@node Remote
c906108c
SS
9294@section Remote debugging
9295@cindex remote debugging
9296
9297If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
9298@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9299For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
9300or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9301powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9302
9303Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9304to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 9305@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
9306but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9307write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9308communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9309
9310Other remote targets may be available in your
9311configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 9312
c906108c 9313@menu
c906108c 9314* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
9315@end menu
9316
6d2ebf8b 9317@node Remote Serial
104c1213 9318@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 9319
104c1213
JM
9320@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
9321To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
9322@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
9323prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
9324program, you need:
c906108c 9325
104c1213
JM
9326@enumerate
9327@item
9328A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
9329have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
9330your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 9331
5d161b24 9332@item
d4f3574e 9333A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 9334subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 9335
104c1213
JM
9336@item
9337A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
9338download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
9339manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
9340documentation.
9341@end enumerate
96baa820 9342
104c1213
JM
9343The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
9344communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
9345machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 9346
104c1213
JM
9347@table @emph
9348@item On the host,
9349@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
9350else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
9351(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
9352
9353@item On the target,
9354you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
9355implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
9356subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
9357
9358On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
9359@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
9360@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
9361@end table
96baa820 9362
104c1213
JM
9363The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
9364machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
9365@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 9366
104c1213
JM
9367@cindex remote serial stub list
9368These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 9369
104c1213
JM
9370@table @code
9371
9372@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 9373@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9374@cindex Intel
9375@cindex i386
9376For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
9377
9378@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 9379@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9380@cindex Motorola 680x0
9381@cindex m680x0
9382For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
9383
9384@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 9385@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9386@cindex Hitachi
9387@cindex SH
9388For Hitachi SH architectures.
9389
9390@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 9391@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9392@cindex Sparc
9393For @sc{sparc} architectures.
9394
9395@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 9396@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9397@cindex Fujitsu
9398@cindex SparcLite
9399For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
9400
9401@end table
9402
9403The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
9404recently added stubs.
9405
9406@menu
9407* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
9408* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
9409* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
9410* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
9411* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
9412* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
9413@end menu
9414
6d2ebf8b 9415@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
9416@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
9417
9418@cindex remote serial stub
9419The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
9420subroutines:
9421
9422@table @code
9423@item set_debug_traps
9424@kindex set_debug_traps
9425@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
9426This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
9427program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
9428beginning of your program.
9429
9430@item handle_exception
9431@kindex handle_exception
9432@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
9433This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
9434explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
9435run when a trap is triggered.
9436
9437@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
9438execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
9439with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
9440protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 9441representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
9442information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
9443retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
9444execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
9445@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 9446machine.
104c1213
JM
9447
9448@item breakpoint
9449@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
9450Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
9451breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
9452way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
9453machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
9454pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
9455@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
9456simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
9457again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
9458your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 9459@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
9460
9461Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
9462to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
9463start of your debugging session.
9464@end table
9465
6d2ebf8b 9466@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
9467@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
9468
9469@cindex remote stub, support routines
9470The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
9471chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
9472debugging target machine.
9473
9474First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
9475serial port.
9476
9477@table @code
9478@item int getDebugChar()
9479@kindex getDebugChar
9480Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
9481It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
9482different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9483
9484@item void putDebugChar(int)
9485@kindex putDebugChar
9486Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 9487It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
9488different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9489@end table
9490
9491@cindex control C, and remote debugging
9492@cindex interrupting remote targets
9493If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
9494running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
9495for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
9496character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
9497remote system to stop.
9498
9499Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
9500probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
9501is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
9502@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
9503
9504Other routines you need to supply are:
9505
9506@table @code
9507@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
9508@kindex exceptionHandler
9509Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
9510handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
9511way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
9512are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
9513containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
9514@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
9515its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
9516might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
9517exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
9518@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
9519and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
9520you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
9521should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
9522
9523For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
9524gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
9525should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
9526@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
9527help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
9528
9529@item void flush_i_cache()
9530@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 9531On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
9532instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
9533instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
9534
9535On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
9536function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
9537@end table
9538
9539@noindent
9540You must also make sure this library routine is available:
9541
9542@table @code
9543@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
9544@kindex memset
9545This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
9546memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
9547@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
9548either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
9549@end table
9550
9551If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
9552library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
9553but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 9554subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
9555
9556
6d2ebf8b 9557@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
9558@subsubsection Putting it all together
9559
9560@cindex remote serial debugging summary
9561In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
9562steps.
9563
9564@enumerate
9565@item
6d2ebf8b 9566Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
9567(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
9568@display
9569@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
9570@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
9571@end display
9572
9573@item
9574Insert these lines near the top of your program:
9575
9576@example
9577set_debug_traps();
9578breakpoint();
9579@end example
9580
9581@item
9582For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
9583@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
9584
9585@example
9586void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
9587@end example
9588
d4f3574e 9589@noindent
104c1213 9590but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 9591function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
9592@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
9593error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
9594one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
9595
9596@item
9597Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
9598your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
9599
9600@item
9601Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
9602the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
9603
9604@item
9605@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
9606@c document that. FIXME.
9607Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
9608whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
9609
9610@item
9611To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
9612as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
9613This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
9614of its pure text.
9615
d4f3574e 9616@item
104c1213 9617@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9618Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
9619Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
9620machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9621TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
9622to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
9623device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
9624
9625@example
9626target remote /dev/ttyb
9627@end example
9628
9629@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
9630To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9631@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
9632terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
9633
9634@example
9635target remote manyfarms:2828
9636@end example
9637@end enumerate
9638
9639Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
9640step and continue the remote program.
9641
9642To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
9643command.
9644
9645@cindex interrupting remote programs
9646@cindex remote programs, interrupting
9647Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
9648interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
9649program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
9650and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
9651interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
9652
9653@example
9654Interrupted while waiting for the program.
9655Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
9656@end example
9657
9658If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
9659(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
9660remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
9661goes back to waiting.
9662
6d2ebf8b 9663@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
9664@subsubsection Communication protocol
9665
9666@cindex debugging stub, example
9667@cindex remote stub, example
9668@cindex stub example, remote debugging
9669The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
9670communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
9671@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
9672these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
9673implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
9674with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
9675organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
9676
9677However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
9678the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
9679target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
9680it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9681
9682In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9683transmitted and received data respectfully.
9684
9685@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9686@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9687@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
9688All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9689sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9690@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9691@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
9692
9693@example
9694@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9695@end example
9696@noindent
104c1213
JM
9697
9698@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9699@noindent
9700The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
9701characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9702eight bit unsigned checksum).
9703
9704Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9705specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9706
9707@example
9708@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9709@end example
104c1213
JM
9710
9711@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9712@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
9713That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9714has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9715since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 9716
6cf7e474 9717@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
9718When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9719response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9720the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9721retransmission):
9722
9723@example
9724<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9725-> @code{+}
9726@end example
9727@noindent
104c1213
JM
9728
9729The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9730debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9731the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9732when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9733
9734@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
9735exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9736exceptions).
9737
9738Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9739@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9740HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9741
9742Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9743@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9744would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
9745
9746Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 9747means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
9748which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9749@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
9750where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9751characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9752value greater than 126 should not be used.
9753
9754Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9755loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9756character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
9757
9758So:
9759@example
9760"@code{0* }"
9761@end example
9762@noindent
9763means the same as "0000".
9764
598ca718 9765The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
9766error number. That number is not well defined.
9767
9768For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9769(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9770protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 9771on that response.
104c1213 9772
f1251bdd
C
9773A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9774@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9775optional.
9776
104c1213
JM
9777Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9778their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 9779@page
104c1213
JM
9780@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9781@item Packet
9782@tab Request
9783@tab Description
9784
df2396a1 9785@item extended mode
104c1213
JM
9786@tab @code{!}
9787@tab
df2396a1 9788Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
656db9b0 9789persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
df2396a1 9790debugged.
104c1213 9791@item
df2396a1 9792@tab reply @samp{OK}
104c1213 9793@tab
df2396a1 9794The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
104c1213
JM
9795
9796@item last signal
9797@tab @code{?}
9798@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9799Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9800and continue.
9801@item
9802@tab reply
9803@tab see below
9804
104c1213
JM
9805
9806@item reserved
9807@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 9808@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9809
f1251bdd 9810@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9811@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9812@tab
598ca718
EZ
9813@item
9814@tab
9815@tab
104c1213
JM
9816Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9817specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 9818See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
9819@item
9820@tab reply @code{OK}
9821@item
9822@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9823
9824@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9825@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9826@tab
9827Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9828transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9829transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9830acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9831to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9832ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9833specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9834that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9835happened.}
9836
9837@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9838@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9839@tab
9840Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9841breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9842@samp{z} packets.}
9843
9844@item continue
9845@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9846@tab
9847@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9848current address.
9849@item
9850@tab reply
9851@tab see below
9852
f1251bdd 9853@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9854@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9855@tab
9856Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9857@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9858@item
9859@tab reply
9860@tab see below
9861
598ca718 9862@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9863@tab @code{d}
9864@tab
d4f3574e 9865toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9866
f1251bdd 9867@item detach
104c1213 9868@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9869@tab
2df3850c
JM
9870Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9871@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9872@item
9873@tab reply @emph{no response}
9874@tab
598ca718 9875@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9876
9877@item reserved
9878@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9879@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9880
9881@item reserved
9882@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9883@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9884
9885@item reserved
9886@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9887@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9888
9889@item reserved
9890@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9891@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9892
9893@item read registers
9894@tab @code{g}
9895@tab Read general registers.
9896@item
9897@tab reply @var{XX...}
9898@tab
9899Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9900with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9901each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9902determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9903@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9904@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
9905@item
9906@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9907@tab for an error.
9908
9909@item write regs
9910@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9911@tab
9912See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9913@item
9914@tab reply @code{OK}
9915@tab for success
9916@item
9917@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9918@tab for an error
9919
9920@item reserved
9921@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 9922@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9923
f1251bdd 9924@item set thread
104c1213
JM
9925@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9926@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9927Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9928@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9929continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9930thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
9931@item
9932@tab reply @code{OK}
9933@tab for success
9934@item
9935@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9936@tab for an error
9937
d4f3574e
SS
9938@c FIXME: JTC:
9939@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 9940@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
9941@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9942@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9943@c described. For example:
9944@c
9945@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9946@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9947@c otherwise returns current registers.
9948@c
9949@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9950@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9951@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9952
f1251bdd 9953@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9954@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9955@tab
9956Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9957present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9958step starting at that address.
9959
f1251bdd 9960@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9961@tab @code{I}
9962@tab
9963See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9964
9965@item reserved
9966@tab @code{j}
9967@tab Reserved for future use
9968
9969@item reserved
9970@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 9971@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9972
f1251bdd 9973@item kill request
104c1213
JM
9974@tab @code{k}
9975@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9976FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9977thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9978
9979@item reserved
9980@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 9981@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9982
9983@item reserved
9984@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 9985@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9986
9987@item read memory
9988@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9989@tab
9990Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9991Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9992using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9993transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9994@item
9995@tab reply @var{XX...}
9996@tab
d4f3574e 9997@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9998to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9999sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
10000@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
10001@item
10002@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10003@tab @var{NN} is errno
10004
10005@item write mem
10006@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
10007@tab
10008Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
10009@var{XX...} is the data.
10010@item
10011@tab reply @code{OK}
10012@tab for success
10013@item
10014@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10015@tab
10016for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
10017written).
10018
10019@item reserved
10020@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 10021@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10022
10023@item reserved
10024@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 10025@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10026
10027@item reserved
10028@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 10029@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10030
10031@item reserved
10032@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 10033@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10034
10035@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
10036@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
10037@tab
10038See write register.
10039@item
10040@tab return @var{r....}
10041@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
10042
f1251bdd 10043@item write reg
104c1213
JM
10044@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
10045@tab
10046Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
10047digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
10048@item
10049@tab reply @code{OK}
10050@tab for success
10051@item
10052@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10053@tab for an error
10054
f1251bdd 10055@item general query
104c1213
JM
10056@tab @code{q}@var{query}
10057@tab
598ca718 10058Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 10059have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
10060company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
10061optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
10062must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
10063@item
10064@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 10065@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
10066@item
10067@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10068@tab error reply
10069@item
10070@tab reply @samp{}
10071@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
10072
f1251bdd 10073@item general set
104c1213
JM
10074@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
10075@tab
10076Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
10077naming conventions.
10078
598ca718 10079@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
10080@tab @code{r}
10081@tab
10082Reset the entire system.
104c1213 10083
f1251bdd 10084@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
10085@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
10086@tab
df2396a1
AC
10087Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
10088This packet is only available in extended mode.
10089@item
10090@tab
10091no reply
10092@tab
10093The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
104c1213 10094
f1251bdd 10095@item step
104c1213
JM
10096@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
10097@tab
10098@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10099same address.
10100@item
10101@tab reply
10102@tab see below
10103
f1251bdd 10104@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
10105@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10106@tab
10107Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
10108@item
10109@tab reply
10110@tab see below
10111
f1251bdd 10112@item search
104c1213
JM
10113@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
10114@tab
10115Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
10116@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 10117bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 10118
f1251bdd 10119@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
10120@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
10121@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
10122@item
10123@tab reply @code{OK}
10124@tab thread is still alive
10125@item
10126@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10127@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 10128
104c1213
JM
10129@item reserved
10130@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 10131@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10132
10133@item reserved
10134@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 10135@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10136
10137@item reserved
10138@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 10139@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10140
10141@item reserved
10142@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 10143@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10144
10145@item reserved
10146@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 10147@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10148
10149@item reserved
10150@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 10151@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10152
10153@item reserved
10154@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 10155@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10156
f1251bdd 10157@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
10158@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
10159@tab
10160@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
10161binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
10162escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
10163@item
10164@tab reply @code{OK}
10165@tab for success
10166@item
10167@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10168@tab for an error
10169
10170@item reserved
10171@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 10172@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10173
10174@item reserved
10175@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 10176@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10177
f1251bdd 10178@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10179@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10180@tab
10181See @samp{Z}.
10182
f1251bdd 10183@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10184@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10185@tab
10186@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
10187breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
10188@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
10189bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
10190the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
10191@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
10192potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 10193implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
10194@item
10195@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10196@tab for an error
10197@item
10198@tab reply @code{OK}
10199@tab for success
10200@item
10201@tab @samp{}
10202@tab If not supported.
10203
10204@item reserved
10205@tab <other>
5d161b24 10206@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10207
10208@end multitable
10209
d4f3574e
SS
10210The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
10211receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
10212@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
10213when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
10214number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
10215conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
10216
10217@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
10218
10219@item @code{S}@var{AA}
10220@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
10221
10222@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
10223@tab
10224@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
10225(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
10226by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
10227thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 10228starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
10229@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
10230extend the protocol.
10231
10232@item @code{W}@var{AA}
10233@tab
10234The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
10235applicable for certains sorts of targets.
10236
10237@item @code{X}@var{AA}
10238@tab
10239The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
10240
6d2ebf8b 10241@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 10242@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
10243@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
10244@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
10245@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
10246this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
10247spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
10248debugger.}
104c1213
JM
10249
10250@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
10251@tab
c3f6f71d 10252@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
10253while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
10254for 'W', 'T', etc.
10255
10256@end multitable
10257
d4f3574e
SS
10258The following set and query packets have already been defined.
10259
10260@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
10261
10262@item current thread
10263@tab @code{q}@code{C}
10264@tab Return the current thread id.
10265@item
10266@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
10267@tab
10268Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
10269@item
10270@tab reply *
10271@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
10272
bba2971c
MS
10273@item all thread ids
10274@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10275@item
10276@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 10277@tab
bba2971c
MS
10278Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
10279may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
10280works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
10281obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 10282be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 10283sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 10284@item
bba2971c
MS
10285@tab
10286@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 10287@item
5d161b24 10288@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
10289@tab A single thread id
10290@item
00e4a2e4 10291@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
10292@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
10293@item
10294@tab reply @code{l}
10295@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
10296@item
10297@tab
10298@tab
10299In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
10300or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
10301respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
10302@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
10303(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
10304
10305@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 10306@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
10307@tab
10308@item
10309@tab
10310@tab
10311Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
10312Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
10313the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
10314thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
10315The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 10316Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
10317"Blocked on Mutex".
10318@item
10319@tab reply @var{XX...}
10320@tab
10321Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
10322printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
10323attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
10324
10325@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
10326@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
10327@tab
2b628194
MS
10328@item
10329@tab
10330@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10331Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
10332digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
10333subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
10334number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
10335(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
10336returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
10337@item
bba2971c
MS
10338@tab
10339@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10340query (see above).
10341@item
d4f3574e
SS
10342@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
10343@tab
2b628194
MS
10344@item
10345@tab
10346@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10347Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
10348returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
10349and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
10350digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
10351a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
10352digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
10353
bba2971c
MS
10354@item compute CRC of memory block
10355@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10356@tab
10357@item
10358@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10359@tab An error (such as memory fault)
10360@item
10361@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
10362@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
10363
d4f3574e
SS
10364@item query sect offs
10365@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
10366@tab
10367Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
10368image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
10369response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
10370offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
10371@item
10372@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
10373
10374@item thread info request
10375@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
10376@tab
598ca718
EZ
10377@item
10378@tab
10379@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10380Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
10381encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
10382@item
10383@tab reply *
10384@tab
10385See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
10386
10387@item remote command
10388@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
10389@tab
598ca718
EZ
10390@item
10391@tab
10392@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10393@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
10394execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
10395Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
10396number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
10397packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
10398stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
10399@item
10400@tab reply @code{OK}
10401@tab
10402A command response with no output.
10403@item
10404@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
10405@tab
10406A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
10407@item
10408@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10409@tab
10410Indicate a badly formed request.
10411
10412@item
10413@tab reply @samp{}
10414@tab
10415When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
10416
0f1f2b0a
MS
10417@item symbol lookup
10418@tab @code{qSymbol::}
10419@tab
10420Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
10421requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
10422@item
10423@tab
10424@tab
10425@item
10426@tab reply @code{OK}
10427@tab
10428The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10429@item
10430@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10431@tab
10432The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10433@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
10434@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10435message, described below.
10436
10437@item symbol value
10438@tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10439@tab
10440Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
10441@item
10442@tab
10443@tab
10444@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
10445the target has previously requested.
10446@item
10447@tab
10448@tab
10449@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
10450If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
10451field will be empty.
10452@item
10453@tab reply @code{OK}
10454@tab
10455The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10456@item
10457@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10458@tab
10459The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10460@value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
10461until the target ceases to request them.
10462
d4f3574e
SS
10463@end multitable
10464
10465The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
10466In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
10467bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
10468space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
10469The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
10470least-significant.
10471
10472@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
10473
10474@item MIPS32
10475@tab
10476All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1047732 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
10478registers; fsr; fir; fp.
10479
10480@item MIPS64
10481@tab
10482All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
10483thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
10484as @code{MIPS32}.
10485
10486@end multitable
10487
104c1213
JM
10488Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
10489does not get any direct output:
10490
10491@example
10492<- @code{R00}
10493-> @code{+}
10494@emph{target restarts}
10495<- @code{?}
10496-> @code{+}
10497-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10498<- @code{+}
10499@end example
10500
10501Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
10502
10503@example
10504<- @code{G1445...}
10505-> @code{+}
10506<- @code{s}
10507-> @code{+}
10508@emph{time passes}
10509-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10510<- @code{+}
10511<- @code{g}
10512-> @code{+}
10513-> @code{1455...}
10514<- @code{+}
10515@end example
10516
6d2ebf8b 10517@node Server
104c1213
JM
10518@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10519
10520@kindex gdbserver
10521@cindex remote connection without stubs
10522@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10523allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10524@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10525
10526@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10527because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10528that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10529@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10530@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10531because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10532also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10533started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10534Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10535the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10536do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10537by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10538choice for debugging.
10539
10540@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10541or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10542protocol.
10543
10544@table @emph
10545@item On the target machine,
10546you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10547@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10548strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10549system does all the symbol handling.
10550
10551To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10552the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
10553syntax is:
10554
10555@smallexample
10556target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10557@end smallexample
10558
10559@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10560hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10561@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10562@file{/dev/com1}:
10563
10564@smallexample
10565target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10566@end smallexample
10567
10568@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10569with it.
10570
10571To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10572
10573@smallexample
10574target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10575@end smallexample
10576
10577The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10578specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10579TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10580expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10581(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10582you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10583TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10584reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10585conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 10586and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
10587@code{target remote} command.
10588
10589@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10590you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10591symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10592using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10593(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10594running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10595remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10596is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10597@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10598@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10599
10600@smallexample
10601(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10602@end smallexample
10603
10604@noindent
10605communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10606
10607@smallexample
10608(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10609@end smallexample
10610
10611@noindent
10612communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10613For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10614the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10615text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10616@samp{Connection refused}.
10617@end table
10618
6d2ebf8b 10619@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
10620@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10621
10622@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10623@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10624allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10625@code{target remote}.
10626
10627@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10628using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10629
10630@table @emph
10631@item On the target machine,
10632you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10633@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10634can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10635host system does all the symbol handling.
10636
10637To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10638@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10639program. The syntax is:
10640
5d161b24 10641@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10642load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10643 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10644@end smallexample
10645
10646@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10647the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 10648to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
10649
10650For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 10651communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 10652using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
10653
10654@smallexample
10655load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10656@end smallexample
10657
10658@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10659you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10660symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10661using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10662(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10663running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10664remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10665argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10666@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10667
10668@smallexample
10669(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10670@end smallexample
10671
10672@noindent
10673communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10674@end table
10675
6d2ebf8b 10676@node KOD
104c1213
JM
10677@section Kernel Object Display
10678
10679@cindex kernel object display
10680@cindex kernel object
10681@cindex KOD
10682
10683Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10684@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10685and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10686mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10687displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10688
10689Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10690@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10691
10692@example
2df3850c 10693(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
10694@end example
10695
10696If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10697about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10698which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10699after the operating system:
10700
10701@example
2df3850c 10702(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
10703List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10704Object Description
10705any Any and all objects
10706@end example
10707
10708Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10709by the kernel.
10710
10711There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
10712is supported other than to try it.
10713
10714
6d2ebf8b 10715@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
10716@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10717
10718While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10719cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10720describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10721
10722There are three major categories of configurations: native
10723configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10724operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10725different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10726are quite different from each other.
10727
10728@menu
10729* Native::
10730* Embedded OS::
10731* Embedded Processors::
10732* Architectures::
10733@end menu
10734
6d2ebf8b 10735@node Native
104c1213
JM
10736@section Native
10737
10738This section describes details specific to particular native
10739configurations.
10740
10741@menu
10742* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10743* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9f20bf26 10744* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
104c1213
JM
10745@end menu
10746
6d2ebf8b 10747@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
10748@subsection HP-UX
10749
10750On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10751begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10752name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10753
6d2ebf8b 10754@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
10755@subsection SVR4 process information
10756
10757@kindex /proc
10758@cindex process image
10759
10760Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10761used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10762subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10763this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10764several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10765@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10766@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10767and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10768
10769@table @code
10770@kindex info proc
10771@item info proc
10772Summarize available information about the process.
10773
10774@kindex info proc mappings
10775@item info proc mappings
10776Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10777on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10778
10779@kindex info proc times
10780@item info proc times
10781Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10782its children.
10783
10784@kindex info proc id
10785@item info proc id
10786Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10787the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10788
10789@kindex info proc status
10790@item info proc status
10791General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10792stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10793received.
10794
10795@item info proc all
10796Show all the above information about the process.
10797@end table
10798
9f20bf26
EZ
10799@node DJGPP Native
10800@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10801@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10802@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10803@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
10804
10805@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10806MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10807that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10808top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
10809
10810@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10811defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10812subsection describes those commands.
10813
10814@table @code
10815@kindex info dos
10816@item info dos
10817This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10818information about the target system and important OS structures.
10819
10820@kindex sysinfo
10821@cindex MS-DOS system info
10822@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10823@item info dos sysinfo
10824This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10825platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10826DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
10827
10828@cindex GDT
10829@cindex LDT
10830@cindex IDT
10831@cindex segment descriptor tables
10832@cindex descriptor tables display
10833@item info dos gdt
10834@itemx info dos ldt
10835@itemx info dos idt
10836These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10837and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10838tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10839that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10840descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10841descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10842rights.
10843
10844A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10845segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10846allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10847conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10848additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
10849
10850@cindex garbled pointers
10851These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10852Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10853displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10854display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10855example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10856debugged program's data segment:
10857
10858@smallexample
10859(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds
108600x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)
10861@end smallexample
10862
10863@noindent
10864This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10865the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
10866
10867@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10868@item info dos pde
10869@itemx info dos pte
10870These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10871Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10872data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10873into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10874page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10875may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10876Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10877that is currently in use.
10878
10879Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10880Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10881the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10882@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10883Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10884means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10885the specified entry in the Page Directory.
10886
10887These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10888Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10889controller.
10890
10891These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
10892
10893@cindex physical address from linear address
10894@item info dos address-pte
10895This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10896address. The argument linear address should already have the
10897appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10898accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10899example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10900the variable @code{i} is stored:
10901
10902@smallexample
10903(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i
10904Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:
10905Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30
10906@end smallexample
10907
10908@noindent
10909This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10910whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10911attributes of that page.
10912
10913Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10914since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10915address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10916be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10917declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10918@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
10919
10920Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
10921transfer buffer:
10922
10923@smallexample
10924(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)
10925Page Table entry for address 0x29110:
10926Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110
10927@end smallexample
10928
10929@noindent
10930(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
109313rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
10932this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
10933mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
10934
10935This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
10936@end table
10937
6d2ebf8b 10938@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
10939@section Embedded Operating Systems
10940
10941This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10942embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10943architectures.
10944
10945@menu
10946* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10947@end menu
10948
10949@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10950various real-time operating systems.
10951
6d2ebf8b 10952@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
10953@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10954
10955@cindex VxWorks
10956
10957@table @code
10958
10959@kindex target vxworks
10960@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10961A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10962is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10963
10964@end table
10965
10966On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10967current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10968
10969@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10970VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10971the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10972both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 10973@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 10974installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 10975@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
10976
10977@table @code
10978@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10979@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
10980All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10981This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10982seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10983your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
10984of a thin network line.
10985@end table
10986
10987The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10988this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10989procedures.
10990
10991@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10992To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10993to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10994library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10995VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10996kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10997source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10998information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10999manual.
11000@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11001
11002Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11003your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
11004run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11005@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
11006
11007@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11008
11009@example
11010(vxgdb)
11011@end example
11012
11013@menu
11014* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11015* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11016* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11017@end menu
11018
6d2ebf8b 11019@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
11020@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11021
11022The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11023network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11024
11025@example
11026(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11027@end example
11028
11029@need 750
11030@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11031
11032@smallexample
5d161b24 11033Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
11034Connected to tt.
11035@end smallexample
11036
11037@need 1000
11038@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11039loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11040these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11041path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11042to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11043
11044@example
11045prog.o: No such file or directory.
11046@end example
11047
11048When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11049the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11050command again.
11051
6d2ebf8b 11052@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
11053@subsubsection VxWorks download
11054
11055@cindex download to VxWorks
11056If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11057object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11058@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11059incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11060command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11061to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11062table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11063the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11064filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11065Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11066to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11067the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11068@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11069and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11070program, type this on VxWorks:
11071
11072@example
11073-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11074@end example
d4f3574e
SS
11075
11076@noindent
104c1213
JM
11077Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11078
11079@example
5d161b24 11080(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
11081(vxgdb) load prog.o
11082@end example
11083
11084@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11085
11086@smallexample
11087Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11088@end smallexample
11089
11090You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11091after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11092this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11093auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11094history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 11095debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
11096table.)
11097
6d2ebf8b 11098@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
11099@subsubsection Running tasks
11100
11101@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11102You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11103follows:
11104
11105@example
11106(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11107@end example
11108
11109@noindent
11110where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11111or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11112the time of attachment.
11113
6d2ebf8b 11114@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11115@section Embedded Processors
11116
11117This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11118configurations.
11119
11120@menu
11121* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
11122* ARM:: ARM
11123* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11124* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11125* i960:: Intel i960
11126* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11127* M68K:: Motorola M68K
11128* M88K:: Motorola M88K
11129* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11130* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11131* PowerPC: PowerPC
11132* SH:: Hitachi SH
11133* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11134* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11135* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11136* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11137@end menu
11138
6d2ebf8b 11139@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
11140@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
11141
11142@menu
11143* A29K UDI::
11144* A29K EB29K::
11145* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
11146* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
11147* Remote Log:: Remote log
11148@end menu
11149
11150@table @code
11151
11152@kindex target adapt
11153@item target adapt @var{dev}
11154Adapt monitor for A29K.
11155
11156@kindex target amd-eb
11157@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
11158@cindex AMD EB29K
11159Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
11160@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
11161@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
11162name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
11163@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
11164
11165@end table
11166
6d2ebf8b 11167@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
11168@subsubsection A29K UDI
11169
11170@cindex UDI
11171@cindex AMD29K via UDI
11172
11173@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
11174protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
11175configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
11176program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
11177use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
11178@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
11179
11180@table @code
11181@item target udi @var{keyword}
11182@kindex udi
11183Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
11184@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
11185This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
11186connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
11187working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
11188to its pathname.
11189@end table
11190
6d2ebf8b 11191@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
11192@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
11193
11194@cindex EB29K board
11195@cindex running 29K programs
11196
11197AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
11198with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
11199term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
11200@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
11201must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
11202board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
11203assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
11204@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
11205
6d2ebf8b 11206@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
11207@subsubsection Communications setup
11208
11209The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11210in DOS on the PC:
11211
11212@example
11213C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11214@end example
11215
11216@noindent
11217This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11218bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11219you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11220end of the connection as well.
11221@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 11222@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11223@c
11224@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11225@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
11226@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11227@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11228@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
11229
11230To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11231the following at the DOS console:
11232
11233@example
11234C:\> CTTY com1
11235@end example
11236
11237@noindent
11238(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11239the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 11240had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
11241
11242From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11243@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11244
11245@example
11246cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11247@end example
11248
11249@noindent
11250The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11251serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11252may look something like the following:
11253
11254@example
11255tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11256@end example
11257
11258@noindent
11259Your system may require a different name where we show
11260@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11261parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11262@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11263system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11264@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11265@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11266@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11267@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11268@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11269@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11270@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11271@c
11272@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11273@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11274@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
11275
11276@kindex EBMON
11277Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11278directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11279start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11280with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11281@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11282@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11283
11284@example
11285C:\> G:
11286
11287G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11288
11289G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11290Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11291Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11292Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11293
11294Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11295
11296PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11297I/O Base = 0x208
11298Memory Base = 0xd0000
11299
11300Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11301Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11302Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11303
11304PageSize = 0x400
11305Register Stack Size = 0x800
11306Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11307
11308CPU PRL = 0x3
11309Am29027 Available = No
11310Byte Write Available = Yes
11311
11312# ~.
11313@end example
11314
11315Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11316typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11317running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11318
11319For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11320way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 11321system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
11322PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11323something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11324other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11325from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11326serial line.
11327
6d2ebf8b 11328@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
11329@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11330
11331Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11332program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11333name of your 29K program:
11334
11335@example
11336cd /usr/joe/work29k
11337@value{GDBP} myfoo
11338@end example
11339
11340@need 500
11341Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11342
11343@example
11344target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11345@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11346@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11347@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11348@end example
11349
11350@noindent
11351In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11352@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11353@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11354In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11355a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11356the name on the Unix side.
11357
11358At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11359to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11360@code{run}.
11361
11362To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11363command.
11364
11365To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11366once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11367@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11368@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 11369Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
11370and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11371
6d2ebf8b 11372@node Remote Log
104c1213 11373@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 11374@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
11375@cindex log file for EB29K
11376
11377The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11378current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11379@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11380of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11381another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11382unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11383
6d2ebf8b 11384@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11385@subsection ARM
11386
11387@table @code
11388
11389@kindex target rdi
11390@item target rdi @var{dev}
11391ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11392use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11393monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 11394
104c1213
JM
11395@kindex target rdp
11396@item target rdp @var{dev}
11397ARM Demon monitor.
11398
11399@end table
11400
6d2ebf8b 11401@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
11402@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11403
11404@table @code
11405
d4f3574e 11406@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11407@item target hms @var{dev}
11408A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11409Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11410line and the communications speed used.
11411
d4f3574e 11412@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11413@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11414E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11415
d4f3574e
SS
11416@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11417@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 11418@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 11419@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
11420Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11421
11422@end table
11423
11424@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11425@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11426@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11427@cindex Hitachi SH download
11428When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11429board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11430board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11431@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11432
11433@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 11434Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
11435
11436@enumerate
11437@item
11438that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11439for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11440emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 11441the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
11442H8/300, or H8/500.)
11443
11444@item
11445what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11446serial device available on your host is the default).
11447
11448@item
11449what speed to use over the serial device.
11450@end enumerate
11451
11452@menu
11453* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11454* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11455* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11456@end menu
11457
6d2ebf8b 11458@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
11459@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11460
11461@c only for Unix hosts
11462@kindex device
11463@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11464Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
11465need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11466first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11467hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11468
11469@kindex speed
11470@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11471@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 11472speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 11473hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
11474the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11475@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
11476
11477The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11478use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11479use a DOS host,
11480@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11481called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11482through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11483to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11484
11485The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11486program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11487sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11488the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11489
11490First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11491board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11492port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11493When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 11494debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
11495for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11496@code{COM2}.
11497
11498@example
11499C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11500C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11501
11502Resident portion of MODE loaded
11503
11504COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11505
11506@end example
11507
11508@quotation
11509@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11510@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11511disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11512your development board.
11513@end quotation
11514
d4f3574e 11515@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
11516Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11517connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 11518the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
11519you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11520commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11521cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11522download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11523the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11524(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11525executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11526@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11527itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11528
11529@smallexample
11530(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 11531@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 11532 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 11533 the conditions.
5d161b24 11534There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 11535for details.
2df3850c
JM
11536@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11537(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 11538Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 11539(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
11540.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11541.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11542.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11543@end smallexample
11544
11545At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11546you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11547sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11548@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11549resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11550@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11551
11552Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11553available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11554you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11555
11556Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11557@itemize @bullet
11558@item
11559to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11560no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11561
11562@item
11563to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11564normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11565to detect program completion.
11566@end itemize
11567
11568In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11569development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11570
6d2ebf8b 11571@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
11572@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11573
d4f3574e 11574@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
11575You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11576Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11577e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11578
11579@table @code
11580@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11581Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11582@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11583@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11584(for example, @samp{9600}).
11585
11586@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11587If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11588specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11589@end table
11590
6d2ebf8b 11591@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
11592@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11593
11594Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11595
11596@table @code
11597
11598@kindex set machine
11599@kindex show machine
11600@item set machine h8300
11601@itemx set machine h8300h
11602Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11603architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11604to check which variant is currently in effect.
11605
11606@end table
11607
6d2ebf8b 11608@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
11609@subsection H8/500
11610
11611@table @code
11612
11613@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11614@cindex memory models, H8/500
11615@item set memory @var{mod}
11616@itemx show memory
11617Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11618@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11619memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11620@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11621
11622@end table
11623
6d2ebf8b 11624@node i960
104c1213
JM
11625@subsection Intel i960
11626
11627@table @code
11628
11629@kindex target mon960
11630@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11631MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11632
f0ca3dce 11633@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
11634@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11635An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11636the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11637@file{/dev/ttya}.
11638
11639@end table
11640
11641@cindex Nindy
11642@cindex i960
11643@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11644@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11645tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11646
11647@itemize @bullet
11648@item
11649Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11650Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11651
11652@item
11653By responding to a prompt on startup;
11654
11655@item
11656By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11657session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11658
104c1213
JM
11659@end itemize
11660
11661@cindex download to Nindy-960
11662With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11663downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11664@value{GDBN}.
11665
11666@menu
11667* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11668* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11669* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11670@end menu
11671
6d2ebf8b 11672@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
11673@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11674
11675If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11676options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11677reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11678
11679@example
5d161b24 11680Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
11681@end example
11682
11683@noindent
11684Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11685identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11686simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11687with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11688use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11689
6d2ebf8b 11690@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
11691@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11692
11693These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11694Nindy-960 board attached:
11695
11696@table @code
11697@item -r @var{port}
11698Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11699to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11700configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11701@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11702device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11703suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11704
11705@item -O
11706(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11707the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11708This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11709target architecture.
11710
11711@quotation
11712@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11713connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11714fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11715attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11716this process with an interrupt.
11717@end quotation
11718
11719@item -brk
11720Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11721system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11722
11723@quotation
11724@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11725requires; it only works with a few boards.
11726@end quotation
11727@end table
11728
11729The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11730port.
11731
11732@c @group
6d2ebf8b 11733@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
11734@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11735
11736@table @code
11737@item reset
11738@kindex reset
11739For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11740system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11741circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11742a break is detected.
11743@end table
11744@c @end group
11745
6d2ebf8b 11746@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
11747@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11748
11749@table @code
11750
11751@kindex target m32r
11752@item target m32r @var{dev}
11753Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11754
11755@end table
11756
6d2ebf8b 11757@node M68K
104c1213
JM
11758@subsection M68k
11759
11760The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11761target command for the following ROM monitors.
11762
11763@table @code
11764
11765@kindex target abug
11766@item target abug @var{dev}
11767ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11768
11769@kindex target cpu32bug
11770@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11771CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11772
11773@kindex target dbug
11774@item target dbug @var{dev}
11775dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11776
11777@kindex target est
11778@item target est @var{dev}
11779EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11780
11781@kindex target rom68k
11782@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11783ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11784
11785@end table
11786
11787If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11788instead have only a single special target command:
11789
11790@table @code
11791
11792@kindex target es1800
11793@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11794ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11795
11796@end table
11797
11798[context?]
11799
11800@table @code
11801
11802@kindex target rombug
11803@item target rombug @var{dev}
11804ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11805
11806@end table
11807
6d2ebf8b 11808@node M88K
104c1213
JM
11809@subsection M88K
11810
11811@table @code
11812
11813@kindex target bug
11814@item target bug @var{dev}
11815BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11816
11817@end table
11818
6d2ebf8b 11819@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
11820@subsection MIPS Embedded
11821
11822@cindex MIPS boards
11823@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11824MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11825you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11826
11827@need 1000
11828Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11829
11830@table @code
11831@item target mips @var{port}
11832@kindex target mips @var{port}
11833To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11834name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11835command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11836the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11837been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11838download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11839
11840For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11841port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11842debugger:
11843
11844@example
11845host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
11846@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11847(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11848(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11849(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
11850@end example
11851
11852@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11853On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11854connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11855concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11856@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11857
11858@item target pmon @var{port}
11859@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11860PMON ROM monitor.
11861
11862@item target ddb @var{port}
11863@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11864NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11865
11866@item target lsi @var{port}
11867@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11868LSI variant of PMON.
11869
11870@kindex target r3900
11871@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11872Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11873
11874@kindex target array
11875@item target array @var{dev}
11876Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11877
11878@end table
11879
11880
11881@noindent
11882@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11883
11884@table @code
11885@item set processor @var{args}
11886@itemx show processor
11887@kindex set processor @var{args}
11888@kindex show processor
11889Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11890processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 11891For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 11892to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 11893Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 11894is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 11895@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
11896
11897@item set mipsfpu double
11898@itemx set mipsfpu single
11899@itemx set mipsfpu none
11900@itemx show mipsfpu
11901@kindex set mipsfpu
11902@kindex show mipsfpu
11903@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11904@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11905If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11906coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 11907need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
11908file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11909functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11910@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11911functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11912with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11913processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11914double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11915@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11916
11917In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11918floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11919and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11920
11921As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11922@samp{show mipsfpu}.
11923
11924@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11925@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
11926@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11927@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
11928@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11929@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11930@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11931@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11932You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11933by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11934@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11935to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11936at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11937
11938@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11939@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11940@itemx show timeout
11941@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11942@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11943@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11944@kindex set timeout
11945@kindex show timeout
11946@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11947@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11948You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11949remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11950default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11951waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11952retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11953You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11954retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11955@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11956
11957The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11958is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11959forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11960to run before stopping.
11961@end table
11962
6d2ebf8b 11963@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11964@subsection PowerPC
11965
11966@table @code
11967
11968@kindex target dink32
11969@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11970DINK32 ROM monitor.
11971
11972@kindex target ppcbug
11973@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11974@kindex target ppcbug1
11975@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11976PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11977
11978@kindex target sds
11979@item target sds @var{dev}
11980SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11981
11982@end table
11983
6d2ebf8b 11984@node PA
104c1213
JM
11985@subsection HP PA Embedded
11986
11987@table @code
11988
11989@kindex target op50n
11990@item target op50n @var{dev}
11991OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11992
11993@kindex target w89k
11994@item target w89k @var{dev}
11995W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11996
11997@end table
11998
6d2ebf8b 11999@node SH
104c1213
JM
12000@subsection Hitachi SH
12001
12002@table @code
12003
d4f3574e 12004@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
12005@item target hms @var{dev}
12006A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12007commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12008the communications speed used.
12009
d4f3574e 12010@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
12011@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12012E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
12013
d4f3574e
SS
12014@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12015@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
12016@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12017@item target sh3e @var{dev}
12018Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12019
12020@end table
12021
6d2ebf8b 12022@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
12023@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
12024
12025@cindex Sparclet
12026
5d161b24
DB
12027@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12028Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
12029@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12030both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 12031@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
12032
12033@table @code
f0ca3dce 12034@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 12035@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
12036@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12037This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12038seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12039@end table
12040
41afff9a 12041@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 12042When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 12043information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 12044load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 12045@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
12046
12047@example
12048sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
12049@end example
12050
d4f3574e 12051You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
12052
12053@example
12054sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
12055@end example
12056
41afff9a 12057@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
12058Once you have set
12059your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 12060run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
12061(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
12062
12063@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12064
12065@example
12066(gdbslet)
12067@end example
12068
12069@menu
12070* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12071* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12072* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 12073* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12074@end menu
12075
6d2ebf8b 12076@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
12077@subsubsection Setting file to debug
12078
12079The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
12080
12081@example
12082(gdbslet) file prog
12083@end example
12084
12085@need 1000
12086@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12087@value{GDBN} locates
12088the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12089path.
12090If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12091files will be searched as well.
12092@value{GDBN} locates
12093the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12094path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12095If it fails
12096to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12097
12098@example
12099prog: No such file or directory.
12100@end example
12101
12102When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 12103the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
12104@code{target} command again.
12105
6d2ebf8b 12106@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
12107@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12108
12109The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12110To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12111
12112@example
12113(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12114Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 12115main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
12116@end example
12117
12118@need 750
12119@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12120
d4f3574e 12121@example
104c1213 12122Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 12123@end example
104c1213 12124
6d2ebf8b 12125@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
12126@subsubsection Sparclet download
12127
12128@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 12129Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
12130you can use the @value{GDBN}
12131@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12132The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12133command.
5d161b24 12134Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 12135address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
12136offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12137of each of the file's sections.
12138For instance, if the program
12139@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12140and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12141
12142@example
12143(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12144Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12145@end example
12146
5d161b24
DB
12147If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12148to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
12149to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12150
6d2ebf8b 12151@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
12152@subsubsection Running and debugging
12153
12154@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12155You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 12156commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
12157manual for the list of commands.
12158
12159@example
12160(gdbslet) b main
12161Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 12162(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
12163Starting program: prog
12164Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
121653 char *symarg = 0;
12166(gdbslet) step
121674 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 12168(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
12169@end example
12170
6d2ebf8b 12171@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12172@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12173
12174@table @code
12175
12176@kindex target sparclite
12177@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
12178Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12179You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12180For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
12181remote protocol.
12182
12183@end table
12184
6d2ebf8b 12185@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
12186@subsection Tandem ST2000
12187
2df3850c 12188@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
12189STDBUG protocol.
12190
12191To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12192manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12193
12194@example
12195target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12196@end example
12197
12198@noindent
12199to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12200the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12201ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12202connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12203concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12204
12205The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12206this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12207would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12208(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12209available on your host computer.
12210@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12211@c basically hearsay.
12212
12213@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12214These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12215environment:
12216
12217@table @code
12218@item st2000 @var{command}
12219@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12220@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12221@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12222Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12223manual for available commands.
12224
12225@item connect
12226@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12227Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12228you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12229sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12230@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12231@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12232@end table
12233
6d2ebf8b 12234@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
12235@subsection Zilog Z8000
12236
12237@cindex Z8000
12238@cindex simulator, Z8000
12239@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12240
12241When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12242a Z8000 simulator.
12243
12244For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12245unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12246segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12247appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12248
12249@table @code
12250@item target sim @var{args}
12251@kindex sim
d4f3574e 12252@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
12253Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12254options, specify them via @var{args}.
12255@end table
12256
12257@noindent
12258After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12259CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12260@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12261to run your program, and so on.
12262
d4f3574e
SS
12263As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12264(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12265additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12266
12267@table @code
12268
12269@item cycles
12270Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12271
12272@item insts
12273Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12274
12275@item time
12276Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12277
12278@end table
12279
12280You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12281conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12282conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12283simulated clock ticks.
12284
6d2ebf8b 12285@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
12286@section Architectures
12287
12288This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 12289all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
12290
12291@menu
12292* A29K::
12293* Alpha::
12294* MIPS::
12295@end menu
12296
6d2ebf8b 12297@node A29K
104c1213
JM
12298@subsection A29K
12299
12300@table @code
12301
12302@kindex set rstack_high_address
12303@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12304@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12305@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12306On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 12307@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
12308extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12309stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12310memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12311this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12312the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12313address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12314hexadecimal.
12315
12316@kindex show rstack_high_address
12317@item show rstack_high_address
12318Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12319processors.
12320
12321@end table
12322
6d2ebf8b 12323@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
12324@subsection Alpha
12325
12326See the following section.
12327
6d2ebf8b 12328@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
12329@subsection MIPS
12330
12331@cindex stack on Alpha
12332@cindex stack on MIPS
12333@cindex Alpha stack
12334@cindex MIPS stack
12335Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12336sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12337find the beginning of a function.
12338
12339@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12340To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12341@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12342you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12343commands:
12344
12345@table @code
00e4a2e4 12346@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
12347@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12348Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12349search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12350default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12351larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12352and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12353
12354@item show heuristic-fence-post
12355Display the current limit.
12356@end table
12357
12358@noindent
12359These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12360for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12361
12362
6d2ebf8b 12363@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
12364@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12365
53a5351d
JM
12366You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12367@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 12368data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 12369described here.
c906108c
SS
12370
12371@menu
12372* Prompt:: Prompt
12373* Editing:: Command editing
12374* History:: Command history
12375* Screen Size:: Screen size
12376* Numbers:: Numbers
12377* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 12378* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
12379@end menu
12380
6d2ebf8b 12381@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
12382@section Prompt
12383
12384@cindex prompt
12385
12386@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12387called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12388can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12389instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 12390the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
12391which one you are talking to.
12392
d4f3574e 12393@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
12394prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12395or a prompt that does not.
12396
12397@table @code
12398@kindex set prompt
12399@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12400Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12401
12402@kindex show prompt
12403@item show prompt
12404Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12405@end table
12406
6d2ebf8b 12407@node Editing
c906108c
SS
12408@section Command editing
12409@cindex readline
12410@cindex command line editing
12411
12412@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12413@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12414command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12415or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12416substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12417debugging sessions.
12418
12419You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12420command @code{set}.
12421
12422@table @code
12423@kindex set editing
12424@cindex editing
12425@item set editing
12426@itemx set editing on
12427Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12428
12429@item set editing off
12430Disable command line editing.
12431
12432@kindex show editing
12433@item show editing
12434Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12435@end table
12436
6d2ebf8b 12437@node History
c906108c
SS
12438@section Command history
12439
12440@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12441debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12442happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12443history facility.
12444
12445@table @code
12446@cindex history substitution
12447@cindex history file
12448@kindex set history filename
12449@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12450@item set history filename @var{fname}
12451Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12452This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12453list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12454exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12455the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12456to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
12457@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12458is not set.
c906108c
SS
12459
12460@cindex history save
12461@kindex set history save
12462@item set history save
12463@itemx set history save on
12464Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12465@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12466
12467@item set history save off
12468Stop recording command history in a file.
12469
12470@cindex history size
12471@kindex set history size
12472@item set history size @var{size}
12473Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12474This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12475@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12476@end table
12477
12478@cindex history expansion
12479History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12480@ifset have-readline-appendices
12481@xref{Event Designators}.
12482@end ifset
12483
12484Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12485is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12486@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12487follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12488a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12489history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12490@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12491
12492The commands to control history expansion are:
12493
12494@table @code
12495@kindex set history expansion
12496@item set history expansion on
12497@itemx set history expansion
12498Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12499
12500@item set history expansion off
12501Disable history expansion.
12502
12503The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12504editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12505or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12506@ifset have-readline-appendices
12507@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12508@end ifset
12509
12510@c @group
12511@kindex show history
12512@item show history
12513@itemx show history filename
12514@itemx show history save
12515@itemx show history size
12516@itemx show history expansion
12517These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12518@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12519@c @end group
12520@end table
12521
12522@table @code
41afff9a 12523@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
12524@item show commands
12525Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12526
12527@item show commands @var{n}
12528Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12529
12530@item show commands +
12531Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12532@end table
12533
6d2ebf8b 12534@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
12535@section Screen size
12536@cindex size of screen
12537@cindex pauses in output
12538
12539Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12540information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12541@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12542output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12543to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12544determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12545printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12546rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12547
d4f3574e
SS
12548Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12549driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 12550together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 12551@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
12552you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12553width} commands:
12554
12555@table @code
12556@kindex set height
12557@kindex set width
12558@kindex show width
12559@kindex show height
12560@item set height @var{lpp}
12561@itemx show height
12562@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12563@itemx show width
12564These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12565a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12566commands display the current settings.
12567
5d161b24
DB
12568If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12569output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
12570file or to an editor buffer.
12571
12572Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12573from wrapping its output.
12574@end table
12575
6d2ebf8b 12576@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
12577@section Numbers
12578@cindex number representation
12579@cindex entering numbers
12580
2df3850c
JM
12581You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12582@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12583@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12584begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12585default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12586numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12587change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12588radix} command.
c906108c
SS
12589
12590@table @code
12591@kindex set input-radix
12592@item set input-radix @var{base}
12593Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12594for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12595specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12596example, any of
12597
12598@smallexample
12599set radix 012
12600set radix 10.
12601set radix 0xa
12602@end smallexample
12603
12604@noindent
12605sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12606leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12607
12608@kindex set output-radix
12609@item set output-radix @var{base}
12610Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12611for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12612specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12613
12614@kindex show input-radix
12615@item show input-radix
12616Display the current default base for numeric input.
12617
12618@kindex show output-radix
12619@item show output-radix
12620Display the current default base for numeric display.
12621@end table
12622
6d2ebf8b 12623@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
12624@section Optional warnings and messages
12625
2df3850c
JM
12626By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12627running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12628command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12629internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
12630
12631Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12632which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12633see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12634
12635@table @code
12636@kindex set verbose
12637@item set verbose on
12638Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12639
12640@item set verbose off
12641Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12642
12643@kindex show verbose
12644@item show verbose
12645Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12646@end table
12647
2df3850c
JM
12648By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12649object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12650find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12651symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
12652
12653@table @code
2df3850c 12654
c906108c
SS
12655@kindex set complaints
12656@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
12657Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12658unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12659@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12660to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
12661
12662@kindex show complaints
12663@item show complaints
12664Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 12665
c906108c
SS
12666@end table
12667
12668By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12669lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12670you try to run a program which is already running:
12671
12672@example
12673(@value{GDBP}) run
12674The program being debugged has been started already.
12675Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12676@end example
12677
12678If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12679commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12680
12681@table @code
2df3850c 12682
c906108c
SS
12683@kindex set confirm
12684@cindex flinching
12685@cindex confirmation
12686@cindex stupid questions
12687@item set confirm off
12688Disables confirmation requests.
12689
12690@item set confirm on
12691Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12692
12693@kindex show confirm
12694@item show confirm
12695Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 12696
c906108c
SS
12697@end table
12698
6d2ebf8b 12699@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
12700@section Optional messages about internal happenings
12701@table @code
12702@kindex set debug arch
12703@item set debug arch
12704Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12705@kindex show debug arch
12706@item show debug arch
12707Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12708@kindex set debug event
12709@item set debug event
12710Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12711default is off.
12712@kindex show debug event
12713@item show debug event
12714Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12715info.
12716@kindex set debug expression
12717@item set debug expression
12718Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12719default is off.
12720@kindex show debug expression
12721@item show debug expression
12722Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12723debugging info.
12724@kindex set debug overload
12725@item set debug overload
b37052ae 12726Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
5d161b24
DB
12727info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12728is off.
12729@kindex show debug overload
12730@item show debug overload
b37052ae 12731Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
5d161b24
DB
12732debugging info.
12733@kindex set debug remote
12734@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12735@cindex serial connections, debugging
12736@item set debug remote
12737Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12738the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12739@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12740@kindex show debug remote
12741@item show debug remote
12742Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12743@kindex set debug serial
12744@item set debug serial
12745Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12746default is off.
12747@kindex show debug serial
12748@item show debug serial
12749Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12750info.
12751@kindex set debug target
12752@item set debug target
12753Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12754includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12755default is off.
12756@kindex show debug target
12757@item show debug target
12758Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12759info.
12760@kindex set debug varobj
12761@item set debug varobj
12762Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12763info. The default is off.
12764@kindex show debug varobj
12765@item show debug varobj
12766Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12767debugging info.
12768@end table
12769
6d2ebf8b 12770@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
12771@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12772
12773Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
12774command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12775commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12776files.
c906108c
SS
12777
12778@menu
12779* Define:: User-defined commands
12780* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12781* Command Files:: Command files
12782* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12783@end menu
12784
6d2ebf8b 12785@node Define
c906108c
SS
12786@section User-defined commands
12787
12788@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
12789A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12790which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12791@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12792separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12793via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
12794
12795@smallexample
12796define adder
12797 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12798@end smallexample
12799
d4f3574e
SS
12800@noindent
12801To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
12802
12803@smallexample
12804adder 1 2 3
12805@end smallexample
12806
d4f3574e
SS
12807@noindent
12808This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 12809its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
12810reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12811functions calls.
12812
12813@table @code
2df3850c 12814
c906108c
SS
12815@kindex define
12816@item define @var{commandname}
12817Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12818by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12819
12820The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12821which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12822commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12823
12824@kindex if
12825@kindex else
12826@item if
12827Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12828It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12829only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12830There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12831by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12832was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12833
12834@kindex while
12835@item while
12836The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12837which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12838execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12839The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12840evaluates to true.
12841
12842@kindex document
12843@item document @var{commandname}
12844Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
12845accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12846defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12847reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12848After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
12849@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12850
12851You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12852documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12853does not change the documentation.
12854
12855@kindex help user-defined
12856@item help user-defined
12857List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12858(if any) for each.
12859
12860@kindex show user
12861@item show user
12862@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
12863Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12864not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 12865definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 12866
c906108c
SS
12867@end table
12868
12869When user-defined commands are executed, the
12870commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12871stops execution of the user-defined command.
12872
12873If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
12874without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12875commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
12876messages when used in a user-defined command.
12877
6d2ebf8b 12878@node Hooks
c906108c 12879@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
12880@cindex command hooks
12881@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 12882@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 12883
c78b4128
EZ
12884@kindex hook
12885@kindex hook-
12886You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
12887command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12888command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12889before that command.
12890
c78b4128
EZ
12891@cindex hooks, post-command
12892@kindex hookpost
12893@kindex hookpost-
12894A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12895Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12896@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12897that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12898pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12899
12900It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12901occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12902
12903@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12904@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12905
d4f3574e 12906@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
12907In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12908(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12909execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12910displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12911
c906108c
SS
12912For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12913single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12914you could define:
12915
12916@example
12917define hook-stop
12918handle SIGALRM nopass
12919end
12920
12921define hook-run
12922handle SIGALRM pass
12923end
12924
12925define hook-continue
12926handle SIGLARM pass
12927end
12928@end example
c906108c 12929
c78b4128
EZ
12930As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12931command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12932you could define:
12933
12934@example
12935define hook-echo
12936echo <<<---
12937end
12938
12939define hookpost-echo
12940echo --->>>\n
12941end
12942
12943(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12944<<<---Hello World--->>>
12945(@value{GDBP})
12946
12947@end example
12948
c906108c
SS
12949You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12950not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12951name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12952@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12953@c or not?
12954If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12955@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12956(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12957
12958If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12959get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12960
6d2ebf8b 12961@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
12962@section Command files
12963
12964@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
12965A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12966commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12967An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
12968the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12969
12970@cindex init file
12971@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 12972@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 12973When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
bf0184be
ND
12974@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
12975@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
12976following:
12977
12978@enumerate
12979@item
12980Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12981DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12982@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12983
12984@item
12985Processes command line options and operands.
12986
12987@item
12988Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12989
12990@item
12991Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12992@end enumerate
12993
12994The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12995complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12996and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12997option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12998
c906108c
SS
12999@cindex init file name
13000On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13001different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13002form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13003different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13004environments with special init file names:
13005
00e4a2e4 13006@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
13007@itemize @bullet
13008@item
00e4a2e4 13009VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13010
00e4a2e4 13011@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13012@item
00e4a2e4 13013OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13014
00e4a2e4 13015@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 13016@item
00e4a2e4 13017ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 13018@end itemize
c906108c
SS
13019
13020You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13021@code{source} command:
13022
13023@table @code
13024@kindex source
13025@item source @var{filename}
13026Execute the command file @var{filename}.
13027@end table
13028
13029The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
13030printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
13031of the command file.
13032
13033Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13034without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13035normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13036when called from command files.
13037
6d2ebf8b 13038@node Output
c906108c
SS
13039@section Commands for controlled output
13040
13041During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13042@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13043explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13044describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13045want.
13046
13047@table @code
13048@kindex echo
13049@item echo @var{text}
13050@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13051@c because it is not in ANSI.
13052Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13053@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13054newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13055In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13056by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13057string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 13058trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
13059To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13060@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13061
13062A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13063the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13064
13065@example
13066echo This is some text\n\
13067which is continued\n\
13068onto several lines.\n
13069@end example
13070
13071produces the same output as
13072
13073@example
13074echo This is some text\n
13075echo which is continued\n
13076echo onto several lines.\n
13077@end example
13078
13079@kindex output
13080@item output @var{expression}
13081Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13082newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 13083value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
13084on expressions.
13085
13086@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13087Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13088the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13089formats}, for more information.
13090
13091@kindex printf
13092@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13093Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13094@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13095either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13096@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13097subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
13098@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13099@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13100@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13101@c supported.
c906108c
SS
13102
13103@example
13104printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13105@end example
13106
13107For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13108
13109@smallexample
13110printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13111@end smallexample
13112
13113The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13114string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13115letter.
13116@end table
13117
6d2ebf8b 13118@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
13119@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
13120
13121@cindex Emacs
13122@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13123A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13124edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13125@value{GDBN}.
13126
13127To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13128executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13129@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13130created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 13131@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
13132
13133Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13134things:
13135
13136@itemize @bullet
13137@item
13138All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13139@end itemize
13140
13141This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13142and output done by the program you are debugging.
13143
13144This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13145commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13146in this way.
13147
13148All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13149with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13150way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13151stop.
13152
13153@itemize @bullet
13154@item
13155@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13156@end itemize
13157
13158Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13159source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13160left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13161source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13162and the source.
13163
13164Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13165usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13166
13167@quotation
13168@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13169current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13170the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13171appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13172environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13173session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13174back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13175avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13176your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13177@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13178
13179A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13180switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13181@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13182@end quotation
13183
13184By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13185you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13186several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13187Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13188
13189@example
13190(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13191@end example
13192
13193@noindent
d4f3574e 13194(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
13195in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13196``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13197
13198In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13199addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13200
13201@table @kbd
13202@item C-h m
13203Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13204
13205@item M-s
13206Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13207update the display window to show the current file and location.
13208
13209@item M-n
13210Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13211calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13212to show the current file and location.
13213
13214@item M-i
13215Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13216display window accordingly.
13217
13218@item M-x gdb-nexti
13219Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13220display window accordingly.
13221
13222@item C-c C-f
13223Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13224@code{finish} command.
13225
13226@item M-c
13227Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13228command.
13229
13230@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13231
13232@item M-u
13233Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13234(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13235like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13236
13237@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13238
13239@item M-d
13240Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13241@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13242
13243@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13244
13245@item C-x &
13246Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13247of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13248around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13249then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13250argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13251
13252You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13253@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13254otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13255inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13256wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13257list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13258formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13259is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13260@end table
13261
13262In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13263tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13264
13265If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13266it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13267request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13268the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13269frame.
13270
13271The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13272which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13273the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13274communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13275delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13276to correspond properly with the code.
13277
13278@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13279@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13280@ignore
13281@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13282@kindex Epoch
13283@kindex inspect
13284
5d161b24 13285Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
13286called the @code{epoch}
13287environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13288@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13289each value is printed in its own window.
13290@end ignore
c906108c 13291
d700128c 13292@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 13293@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 13294
6d2ebf8b 13295@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
13296@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13297@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13298@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13299
13300Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13301
13302Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13303may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13304the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13305reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13306
13307In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13308information that enables us to fix the bug.
13309
13310@menu
13311* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13312* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13313@end menu
13314
6d2ebf8b 13315@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
13316@section Have you found a bug?
13317@cindex bug criteria
13318
13319If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13320
13321@itemize @bullet
13322@cindex fatal signal
13323@cindex debugger crash
13324@cindex crash of debugger
13325@item
13326If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13327@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13328
13329@cindex error on valid input
13330@item
13331If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13332bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13333somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13334
13335@cindex invalid input
13336@item
13337If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13338that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13339``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13340for traditional practice''.
13341
13342@item
13343If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13344for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13345@end itemize
13346
6d2ebf8b 13347@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
13348@section How to report bugs
13349@cindex bug reports
13350@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13351
c906108c
SS
13352A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13353If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13354contact that organization first.
13355
13356You can find contact information for many support companies and
13357individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13358distribution.
13359@c should add a web page ref...
13360
13361In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13362@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13363
13364@example
d4f3574e 13365bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
13366@end example
13367
13368@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 13369@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
13370not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13371@samp{bug-gdb}.
13372
13373The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13374serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13375the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13376newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13377problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13378path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13379we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13380bug reports to the mailing list.
13381
13382As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
13383
13384@example
13385@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13386Free Software Foundation Inc.
1338759 Temple Place - Suite 330
13388Boston, MA 02111-1307
13389USA
13390@end example
c906108c
SS
13391
13392The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13393@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13394fact or leave it out, state it!
13395
13396Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13397problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13398assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13399Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13400stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13401name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13402of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13403the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13404easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13405
13406Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13407bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13408you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13409self-contained.
13410
13411Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13412bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13413@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13414bugs properly.
13415
13416To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13417
13418@itemize @bullet
13419@item
13420The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13421with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13422version}.
13423
13424Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13425the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13426
13427@item
13428The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13429version number.
13430
c906108c
SS
13431@item
13432What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13433``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
13434
13435@item
13436What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13437debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13438C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13439information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13440compilers.
13441
13442@item
13443The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13444observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13445you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13446Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13447
13448If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13449and then we might not encounter the bug.
13450
13451@item
13452A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13453reproduce the bug.
13454
13455@item
13456A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13457incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13458
13459Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13460will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13461not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13462a chance to make a mistake.
13463
13464Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13465say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13466copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13467the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13468crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13469ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13470us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13471to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13472
c906108c
SS
13473@item
13474If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13475diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13476it by context, not by line number.
13477
13478The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13479sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 13480
c906108c
SS
13481@end itemize
13482
13483Here are some things that are not necessary:
13484
13485@itemize @bullet
13486@item
13487A description of the envelope of the bug.
13488
13489Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13490which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13491changes will not affect it.
13492
13493This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13494will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13495with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13496We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13497
13498Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13499of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13500output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13501less time, and so on.
13502
13503However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13504report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13505
13506@item
13507A patch for the bug.
13508
13509A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13510the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13511a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13512to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13513
13514Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13515construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13516through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13517to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13518
13519And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13520patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13521help us to understand.
13522
13523@item
13524A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13525
13526Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13527things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13528@end itemize
13529
5d161b24 13530@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
13531@c and consists of the two following files:
13532@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13533@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13534@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13535@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13536@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13537@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13538
13539
6d2ebf8b 13540@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
13541@appendix Formatting Documentation
13542
13543@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13544@cindex reference card
13545The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13546for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13547subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13548@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13549release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13550you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13551
13552The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13553can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13554
13555@example
13556make refcard.dvi
13557@end example
13558
5d161b24
DB
13559The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13560mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
13561that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13562high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13563your @sc{dvi} output program.
13564
13565@cindex documentation
13566
13567All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13568distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13569a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13570on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13571formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13572and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13573
13574@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13575version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13576file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13577subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13578necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13579but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13580Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13581@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13582
13583If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13584Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13585@code{makeinfo}.
13586
13587If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13588@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13589version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13590
13591@example
13592cd gdb
13593make gdb.info
13594@end example
13595
13596If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13597a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13598Texinfo definitions file.
13599
13600@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13601produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13602document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13603has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13604command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13605(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13606require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13607
13608@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13609@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13610written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13611typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13612and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13613directory.
13614
13615If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13616typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13617subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13618@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
13619
13620@example
13621make gdb.dvi
13622@end example
13623
13624Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 13625
6d2ebf8b 13626@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
13627@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13628@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13629@cindex installation
13630
c906108c
SS
13631@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13632of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13633build the @code{gdb} program.
13634@iftex
13635@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13636@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13637look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13638installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13639@end iftex
13640
5d161b24
DB
13641The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13642@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
13643appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
13644
13645For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13646@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
13647
13648@table @code
13649@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13650script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
13651
13652@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13653the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
13654
13655@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13656source for the Binary File Descriptor library
13657
13658@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13659@sc{gnu} include files
13660
13661@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13662source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
13663
13664@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13665source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
13666
13667@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13668source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
13669
13670@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13671source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
13672
13673@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13674source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13675@end table
13676
13677The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13678from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13679this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
13680
13681First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13682if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13683identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13684argument.
13685
13686For example:
13687
13688@example
13689cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13690./configure @var{host}
13691make
13692@end example
13693
13694@noindent
13695where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13696@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13697(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13698correct value by examining your system.)
13699
13700Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13701@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13702libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13703binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
13704
13705@need 750
13706@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13707system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13708shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
13709
13710@example
13711sh configure @var{host}
13712@end example
13713
13714If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13715directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13716@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13717creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13718you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13719
13720You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13721subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13722configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
13723
13724For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13725the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
13726
13727@example
13728@group
13729cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13730../configure @var{host}
13731@end group
13732@end example
13733
13734You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13735However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13736the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13737that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13738let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
13739
13740@menu
13741* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13742* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13743* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13744@end menu
13745
6d2ebf8b 13746@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
13747@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13748
13749If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13750you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13751host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13752allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13753rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13754handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13755@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13756program specified there.
13757
13758To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13759with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13760(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13761itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13762would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13763the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
13764
5d161b24 13765For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
13766separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
13767
13768@example
13769@group
13770cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13771mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13772cd ../gdb-sun4
13773../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13774make
13775@end group
13776@end example
13777
13778When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13779directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13780(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
13781the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13782directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13783@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
13784
13785One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
13786directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13787@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
13788programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
13789You specify a cross-debugging target by
13790giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
13791
13792When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
13793it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
13794called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
13795
13796The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
13797directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
13798directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
13799directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
13800will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
13801
13802When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
13803directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
13804if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
13805with each other.
13806
6d2ebf8b 13807@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
13808@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
13809
13810The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
13811script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
13812aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
13813of information in the following pattern:
13814
13815@example
13816@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
13817@end example
13818
13819For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
13820or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
13821option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
13822
13823The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
13824any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
13825aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
13826@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
13827script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
13828abbreviations---for example:
13829
13830@smallexample
13831% sh config.sub i386-linux
13832i386-pc-linux-gnu
13833% sh config.sub alpha-linux
13834alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
13835% sh config.sub hp9k700
13836hppa1.1-hp-hpux
13837% sh config.sub sun4
13838sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
13839% sh config.sub sun3
13840m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
13841% sh config.sub i986v
13842Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
13843@end smallexample
13844
13845@noindent
13846@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
13847directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
13848
6d2ebf8b 13849@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
13850@section @code{configure} options
13851
13852Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13853are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
13854several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
13855Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
13856
13857@example
13858configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13859 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13860 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13861 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13862 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13863 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13864 @var{host}
13865@end example
13866
13867@noindent
13868You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13869@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13870@samp{--}.
13871
13872@table @code
13873@item --help
13874Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13875
13876@item --prefix=@var{dir}
13877Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13878@file{@var{dir}}.
13879
13880@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13881Configure the source to install programs under directory
13882@file{@var{dir}}.
13883
13884@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13885@need 2000
13886@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13887@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13888@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13889Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13890@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13891build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13892directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13893the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13894directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13895the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13896@var{dirname}.
13897
13898@item --norecursion
13899Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13900propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13901
13902@item --target=@var{target}
13903Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13904@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13905programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13906
13907There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13908
13909@item @var{host} @dots{}
13910Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13911
13912There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13913@end table
13914
13915There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13916needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 13917
6d2ebf8b 13918@node Index
c906108c
SS
13919@unnumbered Index
13920
13921@printindex cp
13922
13923@tex
13924% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
13925% meantime:
13926\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
13927\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
13928\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
13929\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
13930\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
13931\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
13932\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
13933\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
13934\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
13935\page\colophon
13936% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
13937@end tex
13938
449f3b6c
AC
13939@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
13940@ifinfo
c906108c 13941@contents
449f3b6c
AC
13942@end ifinfo
13943@ifhtml
13944@contents
13945@end ifhtml
13946
c906108c 13947@bye
This page took 0.824096 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.